blob: 12b87ad41cd162a5a29ad104dbeec5ea862de53b [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau5d46fbd2021-02-05 15:17:33 +01007 2021/02/05
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001018.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001038.3. Advanced logging options
1048.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1058.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1068.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1078.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1088.4. Timing events
1098.5. Session state at disconnection
1108.6. Non-printable characters
1118.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1128.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1138.9. Examples of logs
114
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001159. Supported filters
1169.1. Trace
1179.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001189.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001199.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001209.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001219.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200122
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012310. FastCGI applications
12410.1. Setup
12510.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12610.1.2. Proxy section
12710.1.3. Example
12810.2. Default parameters
12910.3. Limitations
130
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131
1321. Quick reminder about HTTP
133----------------------------
134
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100135When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
137on almost anything found in the contents.
138
139However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
140formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
141correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
142
143
1441.1. The HTTP transaction model
145-------------------------------
146
147The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100148to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100149from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
150connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151will involve a new connection :
152
153 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
154
155In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
156establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
157by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
158length.
159
160Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
161to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
162however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
163response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
164header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
165
166 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
167
168Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
169power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
170but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200171a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100173Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
175second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
176page :
177
178 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
179
180This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
181latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
182correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
183the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100184server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100186The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
187time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
188are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
189parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
190carry the stream identifier.
191
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100192By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
193connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
194leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100195start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
196processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
197waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200198
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200199HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100200 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
201 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100202 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100203 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200204 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100206
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207
2081.2. HTTP request
209-----------------
210
211First, let's consider this HTTP request :
212
213 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100214 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
216 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
217 3 User-agent: my small browser
218 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
219 5 Accept: image/png
220
221
2221.2.1. The Request line
223-----------------------
224
225Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
226
227 - a METHOD : GET
228 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
229 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
230
231All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
232which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
233followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
234is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
235desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
236the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
237
238The URI itself can have several forms :
239
240 - A "relative URI" :
241
242 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
243
244 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
245 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
246
247 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
248
249 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
250
251 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
252 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
253 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
254 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
255 must accept this form too.
256
257 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
258 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
259 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100260
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200261 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
262 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
263 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
264 other protocols too.
265
266In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
267mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
268on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
269It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
270specific to the language, framework or application in use.
271
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100272HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100273assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100274
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200275
2761.2.2. The request headers
277--------------------------
278
279The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
280beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
281an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
282Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
283values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
284encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
285the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
286define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
287
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100288Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200289their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100290"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200291as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
292normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
293representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
294HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200295
296The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
297that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
298is one valid form of empty line.
299
300Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
301headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
302about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
303application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
304
305Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000306 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200307 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
308 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
309 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
310
311
3121.3. HTTP response
313------------------
314
315An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
316messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
317
318 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100319 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200320 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
321 2 Content-length: 350
322 3 Content-Type: text/html
323
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200324As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
325codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
326response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100327continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
328the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
329following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
330sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
331(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
332correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
333such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
334state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
335over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
336if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
337information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200338
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200339
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003401.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341------------------------
342
343Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
344
345 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
346 - a status code : 200
347 - a reason : OK
348
349The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100350 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
351 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
352 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
353 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
354 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200355
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000356Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100357"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200358found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
359messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
360or "Authentication Required".
361
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100362HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363
364 Code When / reason
365 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
366 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
367 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
368 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100369 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
370 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371 400 for an invalid or too large request
372 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
373 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200374 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100375 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100377 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
378 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200379 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
380 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100381 501 when haproxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
382 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200383 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200384 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200385 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
386 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
387 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
388
389The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3904.2).
391
392
3931.3.2. The response headers
394---------------------------
395
396Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
397the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
398details.
399
400
4012. Configuring HAProxy
402----------------------
403
4042.1. Configuration file format
405------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200406
407HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
408
409 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100410 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700411 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100412 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200413
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100414The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
415a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100416
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100417 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
418
419 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
420
421 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
422 tab characters
423
424 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
425 keyword sequences listed in this document
426
427 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
428 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
429 parts of the configuration, or expressions
430
431 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
432 are supported
433
434 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
435 section
436
437This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
438generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
439figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
440
441First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
442the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
443a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
444word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
445follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
446the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
447the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
448the parts that need to be addressed.
449
450A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
451requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
452extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
453the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
454section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
455section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
456not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
457
458A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
459each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
460a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
461start a new one.
462
463Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
464that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
465applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
466"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
467processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
468ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
469which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
470In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
471of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
472identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
473such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4742, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
475
476 listen foo
477 bind :80
478
479 listen bar
480 bind :81
481
482Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
483spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
484of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
485following configurations are strictly equivalent:
486
487 global#this is the global section
488 daemon#daemonize
489 frontend foo
490 mode http # or tcp
491
492and:
493
494 global
495 daemon
496
497 # this is the public web frontend
498 frontend foo
499 mode http
500
501The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
502new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
503other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
504section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
505section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
506at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
507
508Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
509are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
510editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
511support automatic indent.
512
513In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
514positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
515modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
516anymore, and is not recommended.
517
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200518
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005192.2. Quoting and escaping
520-------------------------
521
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100522In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
523that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
524possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
525in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
526('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200527
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100528This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
529very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
530the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
531also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
532delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
533word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
534remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200535
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100536If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
537(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
538
539Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
540backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200541
542 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
543 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
544 \\ to use a backslash
545 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
546 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
547
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100548In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
549C-language representation:
550
551 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
552 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
553 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
554 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
555
556Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
557or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
558of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200559
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100560 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200561 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
562 # hash as a comment start
563
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100564Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
565evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
566dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
567backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200568
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100569Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
570character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
571is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200572
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100573As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
574entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
575name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
576represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
577hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200578
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100579 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
580 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
581 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
582 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
583 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
584 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
585 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
586 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
587 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
588 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
589 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200590
591 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100592 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200593 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
594 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
595 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
596 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
597 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
598
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100599There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
600necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
601by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
602they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
603escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
604characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
605case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
606if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
607own quotes.
608
609The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
610quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500611not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100612quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
613
614Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
615arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
616
617 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
618 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
619
620Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
621"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
622cannot write:
623
624 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
625
626because we would like the string to cut like this:
627
628 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
629 |---------|----|-|
630 arg1 _/ / /
631 arg2 __________/ /
632 arg3 ______________/
633
634but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
635parenthesis then garbage:
636
637 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
638 |--------|--------|
639 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
640 trailing garbage _________/
641
642The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
643quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
644processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
645this word:
646
647 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
648 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
649 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
650
651So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
652still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
653the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
654the second level:
655
656 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
657 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
658 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
659 |---------||----|-|
660 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
661 arg2=blah ___________/ /
662 arg3=g _______________/
663
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500664Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100665double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
666
667 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
668 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
669 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
670 |---------||----|-|
671 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
672 arg2 ___________/ /
673 arg3 _______________/
674
675When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
676appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
677string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
678thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
679
680 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
681 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
682 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
683 |-------------| |-----||-|
684 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
685 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
686 arg3 ______________________/
687
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500688Remember that backslahes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100689that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
690quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
691single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
692level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
693
694When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
695double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
696and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
697a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
698a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
699the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
700regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
701around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
702more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200703
704
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007052.3. Environment variables
706--------------------------
707
708HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
709interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
710configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
711optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
712shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200713underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
714list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
715arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
716before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200717
718 Example:
719
720 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
721
722 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
723
724 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
725
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200726Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
727file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200728
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200729* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
730 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
731
732* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
733 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
734 directory.
735
736* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
737
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500738* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200739 processes, separated by semicolons.
740
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500741* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200742 CLI, separated by semicolons.
743
744See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200745
7462.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200747----------------
748
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100749Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100750values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
751otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
752numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
753for every keyword. Supported units are :
754
755 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
756 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
757 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
758 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
759 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
760 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
761
762
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00007632.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200764-------------
765
766 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
767 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
768 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
769 global
770 daemon
771 maxconn 256
772
773 defaults
774 mode http
775 timeout connect 5000ms
776 timeout client 50000ms
777 timeout server 50000ms
778
779 frontend http-in
780 bind *:80
781 default_backend servers
782
783 backend servers
784 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
785
786
787 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
788 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
789 global
790 daemon
791 maxconn 256
792
793 defaults
794 mode http
795 timeout connect 5000ms
796 timeout client 50000ms
797 timeout server 50000ms
798
799 listen http-in
800 bind *:80
801 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
802
803
804Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
805
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100806 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200807
808
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008093. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200810--------------------
811
812Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
813are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
814of them have command-line equivalents.
815
816The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
817
818 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200819 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200821 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200822 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200823 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200824 - description
825 - deviceatlas-json-file
826 - deviceatlas-log-level
827 - deviceatlas-separator
828 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900829 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200830 - gid
831 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100832 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200833 - h1-case-adjust
834 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100835 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100836 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100837 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200838 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200839 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200840 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100841 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200842 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +0100843 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100844 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200845 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200846 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200847 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200848 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200849 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200850 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100851 - presetenv
852 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200853 - uid
854 - ulimit-n
855 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200856 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100857 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200858 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200859 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200860 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200861 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200862 - ssl-default-bind-options
863 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200864 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200865 - ssl-default-server-options
866 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100867 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200868 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100869 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100870 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100871 - 51degrees-data-file
872 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200873 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200874 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200875 - wurfl-data-file
876 - wurfl-information-list
877 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200878 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100879 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100880
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200881 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100882 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200883 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200884 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200885 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100886 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100887 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100888 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200889 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200890 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200891 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200892 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200893 - noepoll
894 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000895 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200896 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100897 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300898 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000899 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100900 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200901 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200902 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200903 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000904 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000905 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200906 - tune.buffers.limit
907 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200908 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200909 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100910 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200911 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200912 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200913 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200914 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100915 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200916 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200917 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200918 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100919 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100920 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100921 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100922 - tune.lua.session-timeout
923 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200924 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100925 - tune.maxaccept
926 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200927 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200928 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200929 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200930 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
931 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100932 - tune.rcvbuf.client
933 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100934 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200935 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +0200936 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100937 - tune.sndbuf.client
938 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100939 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +0200940 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100941 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200942 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100943 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200944 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200945 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100946 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200947 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100948 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200949 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
950 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
951 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100952 - tune.zlib.memlevel
953 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100954
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200955 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200956 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200957 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200958
959
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009603.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200961------------------------------------
962
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200963ca-base <dir>
964 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100965 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
966 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
967 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200968
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200969chroot <jail dir>
970 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
971 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
972 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
973 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
974 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100975 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100976
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100977cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
978 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
979 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
980 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
981 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
982 set. These sets have the format
983
984 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
985
986 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100987 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100988 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
989 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100990 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
991 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100992 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100993 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100994 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100995 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100996 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
997 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
998 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
999 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001000
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001001 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1002 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1003 on the machine's word size.
1004
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001005 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001006 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1007 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1008 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1009 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1010 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1011 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001012
1013 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001014 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1015
1016 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1017 # first 4 CPUs
1018
1019 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1020 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1021 # word size.
1022
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001023 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001024 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001025 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1026 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1027 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1028
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001029 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1030 # and so on.
1031 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1032 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1033 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1034
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001035 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001036 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1037 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1038 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1039
1040 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1041 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1042 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1043
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001044 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1045 # and a thread range.
1046 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1047 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1048 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1049
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001050crt-base <dir>
1051 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001052 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1053 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001054
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001055daemon
1056 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1057 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001058 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1059 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001060
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001061deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1062 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001063 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001064
1065deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001066 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001067 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1068
1069deviceatlas-separator <char>
1070 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1071 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1072
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001073deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001074 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1075 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1076 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001077
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001078external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001079 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1080 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001081 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1082 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1083 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1084 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1085 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001086
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001087gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001088 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001089 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1090 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001091 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
1092 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001093 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001094
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001095group <group name>
1096 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1097 See also "gid" and "user".
1098
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001099hard-stop-after <time>
1100 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1101
1102 Arguments :
1103 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1104 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1105 SIGUSR1 signal.
1106
1107 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1108 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1109 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1110
1111 Example:
1112 global
1113 hard-stop-after 30s
1114
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001115h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1116 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1117 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1118 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1119 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001120 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001121 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1122 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1123 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1124 specified in a proxy.
1125
1126 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1127 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1128 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1129 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1130 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1131 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1132 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1133
1134 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1135 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1136 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1137 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1138 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1139
1140 Example:
1141 global
1142 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1143
1144 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1145 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1146
1147h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1148 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1149 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1150 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1151 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1152 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1153 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1154 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1155 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1156
1157 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1158 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1159 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1160
1161 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1162 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1163
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001164insecure-fork-wanted
1165 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
1166 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1167 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1168 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1169 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1170 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1171 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1172 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
1173 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
1174 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1175 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1176 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1177 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1178 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1179 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1180 disable it.
1181
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001182insecure-setuid-wanted
1183 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1184 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1185 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1186 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
1187 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
1188 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
1189 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
1190 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1191 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
1192 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
1193 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1194 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1195 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1196 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1197
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001198issuers-chain-path <dir>
1199 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1200 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1201 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
1202 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
1203 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1204 "issuers-chain-path".
1205 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1206 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1207 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1208 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1209 will share the chain in memory.
1210
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001211localpeer <name>
1212 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1213 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1214 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1215 the configuration parsing.
1216
1217 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1218 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1219
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001220log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001221 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001222 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001223 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001224 configured with "log global".
1225
1226 <address> can be one of:
1227
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001228 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001229 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1230 port).
1231
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001232 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1233 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1234 port).
1235
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001236 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001237 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1238 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001239 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001240
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001241 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1242 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1243 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1244 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1245 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1246 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1247 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1248 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1249 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1250 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1251 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1252 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1253 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1254 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001255 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1256 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001257
1258 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1259 "fd@2", see above.
1260
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001261 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1262 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1263 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1264 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1265 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1266
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001267 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1268 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001269
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001270 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1271 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1272 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1273 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1274 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1275 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1276 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1277 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1278 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1279 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001280 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1281 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001282
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001283 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1284 one of the following :
1285
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001286 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1287 field is stripped. This is the default.
1288 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1289 rfc3164.
1290
1291 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001292 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1293
1294 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1295 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1296
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001297 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1298 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1299 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1300 designed to be used with a local log server.
1301
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001302 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1303 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1304 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1305 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1306 logger consumes.
1307
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001308 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1309 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1310 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1311 used with a local log server.
1312
1313 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1314 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1315 designed to be used with a local log server.
1316
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001317 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1318 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1319 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1320 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1321
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001322 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1323 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1324 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1325 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1326 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1327
1328 <sample_size>
1329 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1330 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1331 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1332 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1333 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1334
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001335 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001336
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001337 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1338 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1339 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1340
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001341 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1342 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1343 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1344 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001345
1346 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001347 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1348 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1349 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1350 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1351 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1352 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001353
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001354 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001355
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001356log-send-hostname [<string>]
1357 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1358 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1359 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1360 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1361 the logs.
1362
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001363log-tag <string>
1364 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1365 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1366 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001367 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001368
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001369lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001370 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1371 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1372 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1373 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1374 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1375 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001376 used multiple times.
1377
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001378lua-load-per-thread <file>
1379 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1380 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1381 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1382 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1383 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1384 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1385 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1386 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1387 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1388 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1389 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1390 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1391 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1392 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1393 times.
1394
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001395lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1396 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1397 variable.
1398 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1399 to "path".
1400
1401 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1402 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1403 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1404 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1405 will be checked earlier.
1406
1407 As an example by specifying the following path:
1408
1409 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1410 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1411
1412 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1413 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1414 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1415 paths if that does not exist either.
1416
1417 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1418 documentation.
1419
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001420master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001421 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1422 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1423 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001424 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001425 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1426 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001427 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1428 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1429 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1430 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1431 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001432
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001433 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001434
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001435mworker-max-reloads <number>
1436 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001437 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001438 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1439 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1440 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1441
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001442nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001443 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1444 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1445 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001446 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1447 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001448 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1449 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1450 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001451
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001452nbthread <number>
1453 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001454 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1455 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1456 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1457 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1458 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001459 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1460 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1461 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1462 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1463 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1464 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1465 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001466
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001467pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001468 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1469 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1470 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1471 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001472
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001473pp2-never-send-local
1474 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1475 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1476 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1477 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1478 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1479 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1480 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1481 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1482 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1483 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1484 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1485
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001486presetenv <name> <value>
1487 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1488 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1489 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1490 and "unsetenv".
1491
1492resetenv [<name> ...]
1493 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1494 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1495 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1496 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1497 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1498 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1499 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1500 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1501
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001502stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001503 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1504 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1505 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1506 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1507 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1508 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001509 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001510 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1511 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1512 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1513 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001514
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001515server-state-base <directory>
1516 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001517 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1518 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001519
1520server-state-file <file>
1521 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1522 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1523 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1524 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1525 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1526 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1527 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1528 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001529 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1530 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001531
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001532setenv <name> <value>
1533 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1534 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1535 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1536 and "unsetenv".
1537
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001538set-dumpable
1539 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001540 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1541 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1542 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1543 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1544 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1545 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1546 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1547 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1548 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1549 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1550 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1551 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1552 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1553 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1554 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1555 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1556 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001557
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001558ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1559 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1560 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001561 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001562 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001563 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1564 information and recommendations see e.g.
1565 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1566 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1567 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1568 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001569
1570ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1571 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1572 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1573 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1574 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1575 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001576 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1577 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1578 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001579 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001580
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001581ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1582 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1583 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1584 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1585 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1586 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1587
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001588ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1589 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1590 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1591 keyword to see available options.
1592
1593 Example:
1594 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001595 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001596
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001597ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1598 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1599 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001600 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001601 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001602 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1603 information and recommendations see e.g.
1604 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1605 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1606 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1607 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1608 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001609
1610ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1611 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1612 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1613 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1614 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1615 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001616 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1617 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1618 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1619 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001620
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001621ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1622 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1623 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1624 keyword to see available options.
1625
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001626ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1627 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1628 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1629 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001630 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001631 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001632 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1633 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1634 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1635 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001636 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1637 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1638 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1639
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001640ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1641 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1642 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001643 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001644 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001645 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1646
1647 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001648
1649 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1650 and won't try to remove them.
1651
1652 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1653
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001654ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001655 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001656 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1657 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001658
1659 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1660 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1661 optimize the startup time.
1662
1663 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1664 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1665 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1666
1667 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001668 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001669
1670 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001671 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1672
1673 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1674 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1675 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1676 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1677 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1678 bind configuration..
1679
1680 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1681 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1682 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1683 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1684 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1685 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1686 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1687 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1688
1689 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1690
1691 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1692 a cert bundle.
1693
1694 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1695 separately in several "crt".
1696
1697 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1698 since files are loading separately.
1699
1700 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1701 required to commit them.
1702
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001703 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001704 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001705
1706 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1707
1708 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1709
1710 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1711 not provided in the PEM file.
1712
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001713 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1714 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1715
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001716 The default behavior is "all".
1717
1718 Example:
1719 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1720 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1721 ssl-load-extra-files none
1722
1723 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1724
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001725ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1726 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1727 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1728 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1729
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001730ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001731 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001732 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1733 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1734 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1735 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1736 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1737 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001738 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001739
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001740stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1741 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1742 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1743 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001744 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001745 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001746
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001747 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1748 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1749 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001750
1751stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1752 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1753 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001754 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001755
1756stats maxconn <connections>
1757 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1758 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1759
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001760uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001761 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001762 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1763 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1764 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1765
1766ulimit-n <number>
1767 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1768 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1769 option.
1770
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001771unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1772 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1773
1774 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1775 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1776 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1777 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1778 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1779 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1780 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1781 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1782 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1783 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1784
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001785unsetenv [<name> ...]
1786 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1787 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1788 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1789 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1790 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1791 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1792 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1793
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001794user <user name>
1795 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1796 See also "uid" and "group".
1797
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001798node <name>
1799 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1800
1801 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1802 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1803 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1804 traffic.
1805
1806description <text>
1807 Add a text that describes the instance.
1808
1809 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1810 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1811 "<" and ">" characters.
1812
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100181351degrees-data-file <file path>
1814 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001815 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001816
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001817 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001818 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1819
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000182051degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001821 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1822 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1823 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1824
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001825 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001826 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1827
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200182851degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001829 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1830 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1831
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001832 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1833 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1834
183551degrees-cache-size <number>
1836 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1837 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1838 By default, this cache is disabled.
1839
1840 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001841 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1842
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001843wurfl-data-file <file path>
1844 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1845 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1846
1847 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1848 with USE_WURFL=1.
1849
1850wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1851 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1852 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1853 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1854
1855 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1856
1857 Valid WURFL properties are:
1858 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1859
1860 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1861 device.
1862
1863 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1864 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1865
1866 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1867 particular web request.
1868
1869 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1870 used Libwurfl API version.
1871
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001872 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1873 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1874
1875 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1876 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1877
1878 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1879
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001880 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1881 with USE_WURFL=1.
1882
1883wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1884 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1885 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1886
1887 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1888 with USE_WURFL=1.
1889
1890wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1891 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1892 thus before the chroot.
1893
1894 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1895 with USE_WURFL=1.
1896
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001897wurfl-cache-size <size>
1898 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1899 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001900 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001901 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001902
1903 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1904 with USE_WURFL=1.
1905
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001906strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01001907 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
1908 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
1909 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
1910 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
1911 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001912
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019133.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001914-----------------------
1915
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001916busy-polling
1917 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1918 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1919 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1920 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1921 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1922 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1923 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1924 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1925 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1926 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1927 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1928 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1929 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1930 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1931 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1932 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1933 "poll" pollers.
1934
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001935 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1936 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1937 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1938
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001939max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1940 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1941 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1942 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1943 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1944 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1945 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1946 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1947 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1948
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001949maxconn <number>
1950 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1951 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1952 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001953 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1954 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1955 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1956 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001957 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1958 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1959 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1960 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1961 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1962 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001963
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001964maxconnrate <number>
1965 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1966 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1967 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1968 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1969 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1970 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1971 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1972 fairness.
1973
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001974maxcomprate <number>
1975 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001976 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001977 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1978 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1979 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001980 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001981 default value.
1982
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001983maxcompcpuusage <number>
1984 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1985 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1986 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1987 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1988 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1989 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1990 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1991 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1992
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001993maxpipes <number>
1994 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1995 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1996 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1997 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1998 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1999 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2000
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002001maxsessrate <number>
2002 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2003 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2004 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2005 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2006 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2007 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2008 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2009 fairness.
2010
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002011maxsslconn <number>
2012 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2013 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2014 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2015 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2016 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2017 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2018 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002019 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2020 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2021 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2022 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
2023 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
2024 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2025 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002026
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002027maxsslrate <number>
2028 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2029 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2030 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2031 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2032 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2033 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2034 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2035 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2036 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2037 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2038
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002039maxzlibmem <number>
2040 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2041 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2042 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002043 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2044 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2045 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2046
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002047noepoll
2048 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2049 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002050 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002051
2052nokqueue
2053 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2054 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2055 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2056
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002057noevports
2058 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2059 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2060 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2061 also "nopoll".
2062
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002063nopoll
2064 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2065 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002066 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002067 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2068 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002069
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002070nosplice
2071 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002072 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002073 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002074 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002075 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2076 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2077 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2078 "option splice-response".
2079
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002080nogetaddrinfo
2081 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2082 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2083
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002084noreuseport
2085 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2086 command line argument "-dR".
2087
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002088profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2089 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2090 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2091 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2092 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002093 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002094 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2095 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2096 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2097 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2098
2099 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2100 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2101 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2102 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2103 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002104 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2105 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2106 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2107 CLI.
2108
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002109spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002110 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2111 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2112 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2113 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2114 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2115 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002116
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002117ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002118 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002119 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002120 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
2121 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
2122 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2123 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2124 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002125 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2126 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002127 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2128 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2129 openssl configuration file uses:
2130 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2131
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002132ssl-mode-async
2133 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002134 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002135 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2136 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
2137 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002138 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002139 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002140
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002141tune.buffers.limit <number>
2142 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2143 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2144 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2145 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2146 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002147 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002148 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2149 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2150 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2151 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2152 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2153 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2154 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2155 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
2156 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
2157
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002158tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2159 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2160 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2161 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
2162 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
2163
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002164tune.bufsize <number>
2165 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2166 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2167 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2168 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2169 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2170 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2171 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002172 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2173 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
2174 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002175 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002176 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
2177 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2178 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002179
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002180tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2181 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002182
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002183tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2184 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2185 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2186 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2187 this value. The default value is 1.
2188
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002189tune.fail-alloc
2190 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2191 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2192 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2193 gracefully.
2194
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002195tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2196 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2197 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2198 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2199 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2200 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2201
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002202tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2203 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2204 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2205 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2206 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2207 change it.
2208
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002209tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2210 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002211 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
2212 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002213 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2214 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2215 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2216 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2217 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2218
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002219tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2220 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2221 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2222 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2223 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2224 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
2225 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
2226 recommended not to change this value.
2227
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002228tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
2229 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
2230 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
2231 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
2232 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2233 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2234 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2235 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2236
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002237tune.http.cookielen <number>
2238 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2239 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2240 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2241 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2242 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2243 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2244 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2245 to change this value.
2246
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002247tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002248 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2249 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002250 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002251 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002252 configuration directives too.
2253 The default value is 1024.
2254
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002255tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2256 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2257 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2258 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2259 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2260 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2261 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002262 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2263 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2264 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002265
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002266tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2267 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2268 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2269 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2270 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2271 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2272 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
2273 this option to "off". The default is on.
2274
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002275tune.idletimer <timeout>
2276 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2277 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2278 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2279 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2280 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2281 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002282 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002283 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002284 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2285
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002286tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2287 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2288 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2289 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2290 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2291 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2292 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2293 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2294 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2295 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2296
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002297tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2298 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002299 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002300 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2301 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002302 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002303 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2304 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2305
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002306tune.lua.maxmem
2307 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2308 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2309 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2310 memory.
2311
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002312tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2313 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002314 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2315 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002316 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002317
2318tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2319 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2320 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2321 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2322 check servers.
2323
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002324tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2325 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2326 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2327 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002328 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002329
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002330tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002331 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2332 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
2333 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
2334 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
2335 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
2336 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
2337 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
2338 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
2339 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
2340 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002341
2342tune.maxpollevents <number>
2343 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2344 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2345 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2346 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2347 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2348
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002349tune.maxrewrite <number>
2350 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2351 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2352 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2353 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2354 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2355 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2356 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2357 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2358 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2359 bufsize.
2360
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002361tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2362 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2363 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2364 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2365 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2366 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2367 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2368 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2369 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2370 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002371 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2372 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002373 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2374 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2375 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2376 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2377 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2378 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2379 setting this parameter to 0.
2380
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002381tune.pipesize <number>
2382 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2383 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2384 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2385 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2386 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2387 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2388
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002389tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2390 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2391 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2392 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2393 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2394 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2395 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002396 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002397
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002398tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2399 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2400 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2401 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2402 default is 20.
2403
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002404tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2405tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2406 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2407 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2408 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002409 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002410 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002411 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2412 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2413
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002414tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002415 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002416 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2417 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2418 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2419 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2420
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002421tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002422 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002423 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002424 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead. When
2425 experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2426 tune.sched.low-latency to limit the maximum latency to the lowest possible.
2427
2428tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2429 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2430 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2431 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2432 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2433 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2434 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2435 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2436 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2437 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002438
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002439tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2440tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2441 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2442 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2443 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002444 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002445 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002446 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2447 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2448 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2449 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2450 notifying haproxy again.
2451
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002452tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002453 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2454 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2455 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002456 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002457 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002458 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002459 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2460 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2461 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002462 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2463 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002464
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002465tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002466 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002467 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2468 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2469 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2470 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2471 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2472
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002473tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2474 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2475 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2476 performances. This is disabled by default.
2477
2478 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2479 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2480
2481 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2482
2483 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2484
2485 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2486
2487 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2488 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2489 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2490
2491 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2492 converted.
2493
2494 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2495 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2496 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2497 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2498 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2499 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2500 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002501 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2502 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002503
2504 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2505
2506 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2507 only need this line:
2508
2509 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2510
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002511tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2512 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002513 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002514 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2515 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2516 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2517 being used for too long.
2518
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002519tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2520 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2521 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2522 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2523 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2524 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2525 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2526 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2527 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2528 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2529 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002530 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002531 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002532
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002533tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2534 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2535 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2536 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2537 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002538 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002539 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2540 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002541 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2542 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002543
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002544tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2545 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2546 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2547 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2548 1000 entries.
2549
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002550tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2551 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2552 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2553 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2554
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002555tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002556tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002557tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2558tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2559tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002560 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2561 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2562 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2563 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2564 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2565 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2566 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2567 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002568
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002569 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2570 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2571 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2572 all available space is consumed.
2573 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2574 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2575 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002576
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002577tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2578 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002579 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002580 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002581 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002582 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2583
2584tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2585 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2586 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002587 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2588 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002589
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025903.3. Debugging
2591--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002592
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002593quiet
2594 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2595 line argument "-q".
2596
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002597zero-warning
2598 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2599 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2600 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2601 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2602 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2603 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2604
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002605
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010026063.4. Userlists
2607--------------
2608It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2609http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2610it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2611
2612userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002613 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002614 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2615
2616group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002617 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002618 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2619 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2620
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002621user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2622 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002623 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2624 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002625 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2626 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2627 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2628 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002629
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002630 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2631 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2632 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2633 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2634 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2635 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2636 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2637 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2638 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002639
2640 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002641 userlist L1
2642 group G1 users tiger,scott
2643 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002644
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002645 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2646 user scott insecure-password elgato
2647 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002648
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002649 userlist L2
2650 group G1
2651 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002652
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002653 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2654 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2655 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002656
2657 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002658
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002659
26603.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002661----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002662It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2663several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2664instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2665values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2666automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2667In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2668using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2669tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2670reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2671Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2672that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2673each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002674
2675peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002676 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002677 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2678
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002679bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2680 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2681 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2682
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002683disabled
2684 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2685 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2686 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2687
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002688default-bind [param*]
2689 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2690
2691default-server [param*]
2692 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2693
2694 Arguments:
2695 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2696 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2697 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2698 details.
2699
2700
2701 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2702
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002703enable
2704 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2705
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002706log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002707 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2708 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2709 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2710 more details.
2711
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002712peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002713 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2714 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002715 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2716 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2717 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2718 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2719 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002720
2721 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2722 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2723
2724 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002725 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2726 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2727 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002728
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002729 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2730 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002731
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002732 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2733 "server" keyword explanation below).
2734
2735server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002736 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002737 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2738 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2739 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2740 of this "peers" section).
2741 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2742
2743
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002744 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002745 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002746 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002747 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2748 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2749 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002750
2751 backend mybackend
2752 mode tcp
2753 balance roundrobin
2754 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2755 stick on src
2756
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002757 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2758 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002759
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002760 Example:
2761 peers mypeers
2762 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2763 default-server ssl verify none
2764 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2765 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002766
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002767
2768table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2769 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2770
2771 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2772 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002773 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002774 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2775 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2776 "stick-table" keyword).
2777
2778 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2779 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2780 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2781 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2782 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2783 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2784 of the stick-table name as follows:
2785
2786 peers mypeers
2787 peer A ...
2788 peer B ...
2789 table t1 ...
2790
2791 frontend fe1
2792 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2793
2794 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2795 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2796
2797 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2798 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2799 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2800 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2801 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2802 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2803 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2804
2805 peers mypeers
2806 peer A ...
2807 peer B ...
2808 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2809
2810 backend t1
2811 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2812
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002813 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002814 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2815 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2816
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090028173.6. Mailers
2818------------
2819It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2820If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2821in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2822
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002823mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002824 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2825 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2826
2827mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2828 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2829
2830 Example:
2831 mailers mymailers
2832 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2833 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2834
2835 backend mybackend
2836 mode tcp
2837 balance roundrobin
2838
2839 email-alert mailers mymailers
2840 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2841 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2842
2843 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2844 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2845
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002846timeout mail <time>
2847 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2848 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2849 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2850 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2851
2852 Example:
2853 mailers mymailers
2854 timeout mail 20s
2855 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002856
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020028573.7. Programs
2858-------------
2859In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2860master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2861managed the same way as the workers.
2862
2863During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2864sequence as a worker:
2865
2866 - the master is re-executed
2867 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2868 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2869 instance of the program
2870
2871During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2872
2873program <name>
2874 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2875 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2876 the management guide).
2877
2878command <command> [arguments*]
2879 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2880 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2881 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2882 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2883
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002884user <user name>
2885 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2886 See also "group".
2887
2888group <group name>
2889 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2890 See also "user".
2891
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002892option start-on-reload
2893no option start-on-reload
2894 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2895 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2896 program section.
2897
2898
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010028993.8. HTTP-errors
2900----------------
2901
2902It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2903imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2904several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2905
2906http-errors <name>
2907 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2908 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2909
2910errorfile <code> <file>
2911 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2912
2913 Arguments :
2914 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002915 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01002916 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002917
2918 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2919 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2920 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2921 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2922 before any chroot is performed.
2923
2924 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2925
2926 Example:
2927 http-errors website-1
2928 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2929 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2930 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2931
2932 http-errors website-2
2933 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2934 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2935 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2936
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020029373.9. Rings
2938----------
2939
2940It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2941servers or traces.
2942
2943ring <ringname>
2944 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2945
2946description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002947 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002948 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2949
2950format <format>
2951 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2952
2953 Arguments:
2954 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2955 one of the following :
2956
2957 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2958 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2959 designed to be used with a local log server.
2960
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01002961 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
2962 field is stripped. This is the default.
2963 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
2964 rfc3164.
2965
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002966 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2967 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2968 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2969 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2970 is the default.
2971
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01002972 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002973 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2974
2975 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2976 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2977
2978 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2979 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2980 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2981 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2982 logger consumes.
2983
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02002984 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
2985 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
2986 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
2987 with a local log server.
2988
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002989 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2990 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2991 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2992 used with a local log server.
2993
2994maxlen <length>
2995 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2996 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2997 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2998
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002999server <name> <address> [param*]
3000 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3001 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3002 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3003 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3004 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3005 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3006 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3007 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3008 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003009 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3010 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003011
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003012size <size>
3013 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3014 set to BUFSIZE.
3015
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003016timeout connect <timeout>
3017 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3018
3019 Arguments :
3020 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3021 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3022 as explained at the top of this document.
3023
3024timeout server <timeout>
3025 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3026
3027 Arguments :
3028 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3029 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3030 as explained at the top of this document.
3031
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003032 Example:
3033 global
3034 log ring@myring local7
3035
3036 ring myring
3037 description "My local buffer"
3038 format rfc3164
3039 maxlen 1200
3040 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003041 timeout connect 5s
3042 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003043 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003044
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020030453.10. Log forwarding
3046-------------------
3047
3048It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
3049haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
3050
3051log-forward <name>
3052 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3053
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003054backlog <conns>
3055 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3056 on connections accept.
3057
3058bind <addr> [param*]
3059 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003060 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3061 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3062 syslog protocol over TCP.
3063 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003064 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3065
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003066dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003067 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3068 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3069 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3070 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003071 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003072
3073log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003074log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003075 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3076 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3077 documentation.
3078 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
3079 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3080 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3081 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
3082 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
3083
3084 Example:
3085 global
3086 log stderr format iso local7
3087
3088 ring myring
3089 description "My local buffer"
3090 format rfc5424
3091 maxlen 1200
3092 size 32764
3093 timeout connect 5s
3094 timeout server 10s
3095 # syslog tcp server
3096 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3097
3098 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003099 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3100 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003101 # all messages on stderr
3102 log global
3103 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3104 log ring@myring local0
3105 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3106 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3107 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3108 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3109 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003110
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003111maxconn <conns>
3112 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3113 10 is the default.
3114
3115timeout client <timeout>
3116 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3117
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020031184. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003119----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003120
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003121Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02003122 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003123 - frontend <name>
3124 - backend <name>
3125 - listen <name>
3126
3127A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
3128its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
3129section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003130section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003131
3132A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3133connections.
3134
3135A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3136to forward incoming connections.
3137
3138A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3139parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3140
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003141All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3142'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3143case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3144
3145Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3146logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3147proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3148However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3149name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3150
3151Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3152and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003153bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003154protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3155modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3156arbitrary criteria.
3157
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003158In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3159a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003160the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003161
3162 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3163 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3164 between responses and new requests.
3165
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003166 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3167 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3168 client-facing connection remains open.
3169
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003170 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3171 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003172
3173The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3174frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3175following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003176weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003177
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003178 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003179
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003180 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3181 ----+-----+-----+----
3182 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3183 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003184 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3185 ----+-----+-----+----
3186 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003187
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003188
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003189
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020031904.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3191--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003192
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003193The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3194limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3195they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3196limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003197marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003198option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003199and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3200with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3201specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003202
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003203
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003204 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3205------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3206acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003207backlog X X X -
3208balance X - X X
3209bind - X X -
3210bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003211capture cookie - X X -
3212capture request header - X X -
3213capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003214clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3215clitcpka-idle X X X -
3216clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003217compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003218cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003219declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003220default-server X - X X
3221default_backend X X X -
3222description - X X X
3223disabled X X X X
3224dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003225email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003226email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003227email-alert mailers X X X X
3228email-alert myhostname X X X X
3229email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003230enabled X X X X
3231errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003232errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003233errorloc X X X X
3234errorloc302 X X X X
3235-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3236errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003237force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003238filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003239fullconn X - X X
3240grace X X X X
3241hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003242http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003243http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003244http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003245http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003246http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003247http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003248http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003249http-check set-var X - X X
3250http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003251http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003252http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003253http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003254http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003255http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003256id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003257ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003258load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003259log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003260log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003261log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003262log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003263max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003264maxconn X X X -
3265mode X X X X
3266monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003267monitor-uri X X X -
3268option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3269option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3270option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3271option allbackups (*) X - X X
3272option checkcache (*) X - X X
3273option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3274option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003275option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003276option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3277option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003278-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3279option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003280option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3281option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003282option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003283option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003284option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003285option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003286option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003287option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3288option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3289option httpchk X - X X
3290option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003291option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003292option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003293option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003294option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003295option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003296option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3297option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3298option logasap (*) X X X -
3299option mysql-check X - X X
3300option nolinger (*) X X X X
3301option originalto X X X X
3302option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003303option pgsql-check X - X X
3304option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003305option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003306option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003307option smtpchk X - X X
3308option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3309option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3310option splice-request (*) X X X X
3311option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003312option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003313option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3314option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3315-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003316option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003317option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3318option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3319option tcpka X X X X
3320option tcplog X X X X
3321option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003322external-check command X - X X
3323external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003324persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3325rate-limit sessions X X X -
3326redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003327-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003328retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003329retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003330server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003331server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003332server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003333source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003334srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3335srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3336srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003337stats admin - X X X
3338stats auth X X X X
3339stats enable X X X X
3340stats hide-version X X X X
3341stats http-request - X X X
3342stats realm X X X X
3343stats refresh X X X X
3344stats scope X X X X
3345stats show-desc X X X X
3346stats show-legends X X X X
3347stats show-node X X X X
3348stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003349-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3350stick match - - X X
3351stick on - - X X
3352stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003353stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003354stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003355tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003356tcp-check connect X - X X
3357tcp-check expect X - X X
3358tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003359tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003360tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003361tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003362tcp-check set-var X - X X
3363tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003364tcp-request connection - X X -
3365tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003366tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003367tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003368tcp-response content - - X X
3369tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003370timeout check X - X X
3371timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003372timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003373timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003374timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3375timeout http-request X X X X
3376timeout queue X - X X
3377timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003378timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003379timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003380timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003381transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003382unique-id-format X X X -
3383unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003384use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003385use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003386use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003387------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3388 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003389
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003390
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033914.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3392---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003393
3394This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3395
3396
3397acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3398 Declare or complete an access list.
3399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3400 no | yes | yes | yes
3401 Example:
3402 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3403 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3404 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003406 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003407
3408
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003409backlog <conns>
3410 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3412 yes | yes | yes | no
3413 Arguments :
3414 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3415 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003416 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003417
3418 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3419 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3420 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3421 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3422 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3423 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3424 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3425 backlog parameter.
3426
3427 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3428 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3429 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3430
3431 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3432
3433
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003434balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003435balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003436 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3438 yes | no | yes | yes
3439 Arguments :
3440 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3441 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3442 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3443 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3444
3445 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3446 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3447 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3448 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003449 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003450 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003451 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3452 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3453 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3454 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3455 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3456 it, so that you don't worry.
3457
3458 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3459 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3460 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3461 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3462 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3463 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3464 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3465 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003466
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003467 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3468 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3469 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3470 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3471 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3472 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3473 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003474 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3475 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3476 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003477
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003478 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003479 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003480 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3481 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003482 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003483 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3484 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3485 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3486 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3487 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003488 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3489 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3490 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3491 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3492 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3493 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003494
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003495 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3496 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3497 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3498 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3499 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3500 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3501 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3502 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003503 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003504 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003505 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3506 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3507 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003508
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003509 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3510 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3511 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3512 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3513 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3514 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3515 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3516 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3517 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3518 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3519 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3520 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003521
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003522 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003523 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3524 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3525 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3526 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3527 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3528 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3529 URIs start with a leading "/".
3530
3531 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3532 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3533 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3534 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3535
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003536 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3537 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3538 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3539 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3540
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003541 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003542 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3543
3544 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003545 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3546 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003547 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3548 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3549 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3550 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003551 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003552 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3553 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003554
3555 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3556 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3557 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3558 server will receive the request.
3559
3560 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3561 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3562 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3563 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3564 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003565 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3566 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3567 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003568
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003569 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3570 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3571 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3572 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3573 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003574
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003575 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003576 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3577 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3578 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3579
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003580 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3581 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3582 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3583
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003584 random
3585 random(<draws>)
3586 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003587 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3588 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3589 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3590 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003591 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3592 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3593 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3594 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3595 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3596 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3597 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3598 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3599 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3600 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3601 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3602 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3603 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3604 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3605 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3606 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3607 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3608 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3609 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3610 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003611
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003612 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003613 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003614 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3615 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3616 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3617 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3618 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3619 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003620 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003621 used instead.
3622
3623 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3624 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3625 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3626 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3627
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003628 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3629 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3630 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3631
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003632 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003633
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003634 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003635 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3636 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003637
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003638 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3639 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3640 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003641
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003642 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003643 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003644 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3645 NTLM relies on.
3646
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003647 Examples :
3648 balance roundrobin
3649 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003650 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003651 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3652 balance hdr(host)
3653 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003654
3655 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3656 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3657
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003658 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003659 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3660 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3661 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003662 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003663
3664 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3665 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3666 defaults to 16 kB.
3667
3668 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3669 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3670
3671 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3672 Round Robin.
3673
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003674 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003675 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3676 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3677 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3678
3679 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3680
3681 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003682 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003683 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3684 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3685 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003686
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003687 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003688
3689
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003690bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3691bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003692 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3694 no | yes | yes | no
3695 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003696 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3697 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3698 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3699 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003700 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003701 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3702 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3703 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3704 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3705 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3706 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003707 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003708 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3709 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003710 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003711 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3712 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003713 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003714 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3715 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003716 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003717 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3718 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3719 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3720 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3721 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3722 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3723 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003724 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3725 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3726 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003727 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3728 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3729 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3730 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003731 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3732 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3733 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003734
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003735 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3736 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003737 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3738 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3739 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003740 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3741 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3742 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3743 the range.
3744
3745 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3746 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3747 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3748 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3749 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3750 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3751 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003752 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003753 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003754
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003755 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003756 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003757 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3758 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3759 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3760 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3761 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3762 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3763
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003764 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3765 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3766 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3767 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003768
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003769 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3770 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3771 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3772 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3773 in a frontend.
3774
3775 Example :
3776 listen http_proxy
3777 bind :80,:443
3778 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003779 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003780
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003781 listen http_https_proxy
3782 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003783 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003784
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003785 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3786 bind ipv6@:80
3787 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3788 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3789
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003790 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003791 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003792
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003793 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3794 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3795 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3796 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3797 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3798
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003799 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003800 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003801
3802
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003803bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003804 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3806 yes | yes | yes | yes
3807 Arguments :
3808 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3809 may be used to override a default value.
3810
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003811 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003812 option may be combined with other numbers.
3813
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003814 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003815 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3816 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3817 missing from all processes.
3818
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003819 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003820 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003821 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3822 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3823 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3824 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3825 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003826 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003827
3828 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3829 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3830 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3831 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3832 and 'even' instances.
3833
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003834 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3835 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3836 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3837 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003838
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003839 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3840 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3841
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003842 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3843 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3844 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3845
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003846 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3847 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3848
3849 Example :
3850 listen app_ip1
3851 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003852 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003853
3854 listen app_ip2
3855 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003856 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003857
3858 listen management
3859 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003860 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003861
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003862 listen management
3863 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3864 bind-process 1-4
3865
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003866 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003867
3868
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003869capture cookie <name> len <length>
3870 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3872 no | yes | yes | no
3873 Arguments :
3874 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3875 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3876 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3877 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003878 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003879
3880 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3881 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3882 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3883 right if it exceeds <length>.
3884
3885 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3886 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3887 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3888 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3889
3890 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3891 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3892 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3893
3894 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3895 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3896 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003897 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3898 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3899 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003900
3901 Example:
3902 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3903
3904 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003905 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003906
3907
3908capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003909 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3911 no | yes | yes | no
3912 Arguments :
3913 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003914 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003915 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3916 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3917 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3918
3919 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3920 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3921 it exceeds <length>.
3922
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003923 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003924 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3925 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003926 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3927 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3928 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3929 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003930 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003931 environments to find where the request came from.
3932
3933 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3934 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3935 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3936 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003937
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003938 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3939 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3940 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3941 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3942 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003943
3944 Example:
3945 capture request header Host len 15
3946 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003947 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003948
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003949 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003950 about logging.
3951
3952
3953capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003954 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3956 no | yes | yes | no
3957 Arguments :
3958 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003959 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003960 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3961 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3962 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3963
3964 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3965 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3966 it exceeds <length>.
3967
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003968 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003969 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3970 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3971 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003972 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3973 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3974 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3975 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003976
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003977 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3978 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3979 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3980 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3981 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003982
3983 Example:
3984 capture response header Content-length len 9
3985 capture response header Location len 15
3986
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003987 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003988 about logging.
3989
3990
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003991clitcpka-cnt <count>
3992 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
3993 the connection on the client side.
3994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3995 yes | yes | yes | no
3996 Arguments :
3997 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
3998
3999 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4000 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004001 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4002 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004003
4004 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4005
4006
4007clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4008 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4009 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4010 client side.
4011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4012 yes | yes | yes | no
4013 Arguments :
4014 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4015 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4016 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4017 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4018
4019 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4020 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004021 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4022 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004023
4024 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4025
4026
4027clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4028 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4030 yes | yes | yes | no
4031 Arguments :
4032 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4033 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4034 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4035 document.
4036
4037 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4038 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004039 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4040 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004041
4042 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4043
4044
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004045compression algo <algorithm> ...
4046compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004047compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004048 Enable HTTP compression.
4049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4050 yes | yes | yes | yes
4051 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004052 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4053 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
4054 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
4055
4056 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004057 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4058 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4059 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004060
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004061 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004062 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004063
4064 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4065 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4066 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4067 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4068 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004069 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004070
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004071 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4072 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4073 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4074 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4075 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4076 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4077 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004078 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004079
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004080 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004081 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004082 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
4083 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
4084 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
4085 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
4086 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004087
4088 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4089 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4090 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4091 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
4092 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004093 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4094 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4095 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4096 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4097 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004098 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4099 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004100
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004101 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004102 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4103 "Accept-Encoding" header
4104 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004105 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004106 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4107 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4108 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4109 "multipart"
4110 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4111 header
4112 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4113 and later
4114 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4115 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004116 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004117
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004118 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004119
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004120 Examples :
4121 compression algo gzip
4122 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004123
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004124
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004125cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004126 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4127 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004128 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004129 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4131 yes | no | yes | yes
4132 Arguments :
4133 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4134 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4135 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4136 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4137 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4138 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004139 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004140 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4141 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4142
4143 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
4144 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
4145 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4146 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4147 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4148 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004149 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4150 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004151 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004152 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4153 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004154
4155 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004156 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004157
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004158 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004159 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004160 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004161 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004162 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4163 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4164 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4165 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4166 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4167 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4168 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004169
4170 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4171 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4172 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4173 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4174 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4175 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4176 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4177 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4178 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004179 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004180 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4181 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4182 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004183
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004184 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4185 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4186 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004187 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4188 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4189 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4190 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004191 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4192 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4193 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004194
4195 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4196 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4197 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4198 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4199 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4200 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4201 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4202 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4203 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4204
4205 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4206 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4207 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4208 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4209 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4210 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4211 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4212 persistence cookie in the cache.
4213 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4214
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004215 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4216 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
4217 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
4218 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4219 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004220 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004221 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4222 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4223 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4224 they logout.
4225
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004226 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
4227 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4228 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4229 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4230
4231 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
4232 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4233 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4234 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4235 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4236 this attribute.
4237
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004238 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004239 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004240 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4241 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4242 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4243 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4244 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4245 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004246
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004247 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4248 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4249 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4250 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4251 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4252 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4253 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4254 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004255 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004256 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4257 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4258 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4259 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4260 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4261 the site.
4262
4263 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4264 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4265 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4266 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4267 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4268 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4269 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4270 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4271 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4272 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4273 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4274 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4275 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004276 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004277 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4278 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4279
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004280 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4281 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4282 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4283 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4284 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4285 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4286
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004287 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4288 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4289 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4290 repeated.
4291
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004292 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4293 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4294 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4295 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004296
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004297 Examples :
4298 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4299 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4300 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004301 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004302
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004303 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004304
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004305
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004306declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4307 Declares a capture slot.
4308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4309 no | yes | yes | no
4310 Arguments:
4311 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4312
4313 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4314 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4315 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4316 for use in the response.
4317
4318 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004319 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004320 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4321
4322
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004323default-server [param*]
4324 Change default options for a server in a backend
4325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4326 yes | no | yes | yes
4327 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004328 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4329 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4330 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4331 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004332
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004333 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004334 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4335
4336 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004337
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004338
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004339default_backend <backend>
4340 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4342 yes | yes | yes | no
4343 Arguments :
4344 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4345
4346 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4347 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4348 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4349 will catch all undetermined requests.
4350
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004351 Example :
4352
4353 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4354 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4355 default_backend dynamic
4356
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004357 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004358
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004359
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004360description <string>
4361 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4363 no | yes | yes | yes
4364 Arguments : string
4365
4366 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4367 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4368 it describes.
4369 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4370
4371
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004372disabled
4373 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4375 yes | yes | yes | yes
4376 Arguments : none
4377
4378 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4379 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4380 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4381 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4382 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4383 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4384 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4385
4386 See also : "enabled"
4387
4388
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004389dispatch <address>:<port>
4390 Set a default server address
4391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4392 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004393 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004394
4395 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4396 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4397 during start-up.
4398
4399 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4400 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4401 possible with normal servers.
4402
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004403 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004404 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4405 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4406 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4407 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4408
4409 See also : "server"
4410
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004411
4412dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4413 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4415 yes | no | yes | yes
4416 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4417
4418 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004419 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004420 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4421 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004422 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004423 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004424
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004425enabled
4426 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4428 yes | yes | yes | yes
4429 Arguments : none
4430
4431 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4432 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4433
4434 See also : "disabled"
4435
4436
4437errorfile <code> <file>
4438 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4440 yes | yes | yes | yes
4441 Arguments :
4442 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004443 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004444 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004445
4446 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004447 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004448 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004449 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4450 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004451
4452 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4453 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4454 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4455
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004456 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4457
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004458 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4459 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4460 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4461 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4462 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4463 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4464 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4465 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4466 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004467
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004468 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4469 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4470 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004471 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004472 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4473
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004474 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004475
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004476 Example :
4477 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004478 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004479 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4480 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4481
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004482
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004483errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4484 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4485 section.
4486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4487 yes | yes | yes | yes
4488 Arguments :
4489 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4490
4491 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004492 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004493 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4494 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004495
4496 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4497 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4498 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4499 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4500 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004501 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004502 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4503
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004504 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4505 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004506
4507 Example :
4508 errorfiles generic
4509 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4510
4511
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004512errorloc <code> <url>
4513errorloc302 <code> <url>
4514 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4516 yes | yes | yes | yes
4517 Arguments :
4518 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004519 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004520 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004521
4522 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4523 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4524 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4525 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004526 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004527
4528 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4529 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4530 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4531
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004532 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4533
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004534 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4535 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4536 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4537 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004538 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004539 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4540 request.
4541
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004542 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004543
4544
4545errorloc303 <code> <url>
4546 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4548 yes | yes | yes | yes
4549 Arguments :
4550 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004551 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004552 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004553
4554 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4555 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4556 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4557 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004558 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004559
4560 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4561 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4562 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4563
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004564 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4565
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004566 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4567 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4568 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4569 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004570 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004571
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004572 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004573
4574
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004575email-alert from <emailaddr>
4576 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004577 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004578 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4579 yes | yes | yes | yes
4580
4581 Arguments :
4582
4583 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4584
4585 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4586 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4587
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004588 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004589 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4590 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004591
4592
4593email-alert level <level>
4594 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4595 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4596 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4597 yes | yes | yes | yes
4598
4599 Arguments :
4600
4601 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4602 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4603 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4604
4605 By default level is alert
4606
4607 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4608 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4609 for the proxy.
4610
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004611 Alerts are sent when :
4612
4613 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4614 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4615 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4616 is notice or lower
4617 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4618 and a health check status update occurs
4619
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004620 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4621 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004622 section 3.6 about mailers.
4623
4624
4625email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4626 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4627 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4628 yes | yes | yes | yes
4629
4630 Arguments :
4631
4632 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4633
4634 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4635 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4636
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004637 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4638 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004639
4640
4641email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4642 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4643 mailers.
4644 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4645 yes | yes | yes | yes
4646
4647 Arguments :
4648
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004649 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004650
4651 By default the systems hostname is used.
4652
4653 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4654 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4655 for the proxy.
4656
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004657 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4658 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004659
4660
4661email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004662 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004663 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4664 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4665 yes | yes | yes | yes
4666
4667 Arguments :
4668
4669 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4670
4671 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4672 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4673
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004674 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004675 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4676
4677
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004678force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4679 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4680 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004681 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004682
4683 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4684 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4685 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4686 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4687 marked down for maintenance operations.
4688
4689 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4690 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4691 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4692 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4693 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4694 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4695 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4696 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4697 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4698
4699 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4700 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4701 is used.
4702
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004703 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004704 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004705
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004706
4707filter <name> [param*]
4708 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4710 no | yes | yes | yes
4711 Arguments :
4712 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4713 referenced in section 9.
4714
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004715 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004716 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004717 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4718 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004719
4720 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4721 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4722
4723 Example:
4724 listen
4725 bind *:80
4726
4727 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4728 filter compression
4729 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4730
4731 compression algo gzip
4732 compression offload
4733
4734 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4735
4736 See also : section 9.
4737
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004738
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004739fullconn <conns>
4740 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4742 yes | no | yes | yes
4743 Arguments :
4744 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4745 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4746
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004747 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004748 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004749 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004750 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4751 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4752 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4753 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4754 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004755 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004756
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004757 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4758 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004759 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4760 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4761 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004762
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004763 Example :
4764 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4765 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4766 # connections.
4767 backend dynamic
4768 fullconn 10000
4769 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4770 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4771
4772 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4773
4774
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02004775grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004776 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004778 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004779 Arguments :
4780 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4781 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4782 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4783
4784 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4785 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004786 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004787 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4788
4789 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4790 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4791 simplify it.
4792
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004793
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004794hash-balance-factor <factor>
4795 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4797 yes | no | no | yes
4798 Arguments :
4799 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4800 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004801 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004802
4803 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4804 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4805 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4806 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4807 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4808 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4809 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4810
4811 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4812 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4813 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4814 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4815 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4816
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004817 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4818 consistent hashing mechanism.
4819
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004820 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4821
4822
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004823hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004824 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4826 yes | no | yes | yes
4827 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004828 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4829 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004830
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004831 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4832 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4833 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4834 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4835 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4836 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4837 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4838 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4839 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4840 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004841
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004842 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4843 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4844 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4845 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4846 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4847 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4848 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4849 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4850 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4851 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4852 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4853 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4854 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004855 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4856 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004857
4858 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4859
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004860 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004861 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4862 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4863 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004864 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4865 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4866 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004867
4868 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4869 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004870 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4871 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4872 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4873 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4874
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004875 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4876 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4877 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4878 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4879 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4880 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4881 parameter.
4882
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004883 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4884 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4885 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4886 used on strings.
4887
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004888 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4889
4890 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4891 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4892 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4893 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4894 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4895 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4896 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4897 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4898 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4899 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4900 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4901 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004902
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004903 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4904 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4905 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004906
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004907 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004908
4909
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004910http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4911 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4912 ones).
4913
4914 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4915 no | yes | yes | yes
4916
4917 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4918 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4919 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4920 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4921 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4922 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4923
4924 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4925 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4926 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4927
4928 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4929 below.
4930
4931 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4932 instance.
4933
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01004934 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
4935 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
4936 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
4937
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004938 Example:
4939 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4940 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4941 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4942
4943http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4944
4945 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4946 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4947 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4948 example, or to pass some internal information.
4949 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4950 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4951 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4952
4953http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4954
4955 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4956 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4957
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00004958http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004959
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00004960 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
4961 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
4962 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
4963 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
4964 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004965
4966http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4967 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4968
4969 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4970
4971 Example:
4972 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4973
4974 # applied to:
4975 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4976
4977 # outputs:
4978 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4979
4980 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4981
4982http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4983 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4984
4985 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4986
4987 Example:
4988 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4989
4990 # applied to:
4991 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4992
4993 # outputs:
4994 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4995
4996http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4997
4998 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4999 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5000 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5001
5002http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5003 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5004
5005 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5006 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5007 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5008 fallback.
5009
5010 Example:
5011 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5012 http-response set-status 431
5013 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5014 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5015
5016http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5017
5018 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5019 inline.
5020
5021 Arguments:
5022 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5023 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5024 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5025 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5026 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5027 (request and response)
5028 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5029 processing
5030 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5031 processing
5032 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5033 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5034 and '_'.
5035
5036 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5037 followed by some converters.
5038
5039 Example:
5040 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5041
5042http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5043
5044 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5045 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5046 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5047 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5048 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005049 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005050 processing.
5051
5052 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5053 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005054 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005055 rules evaluation.
5056
5057http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5058
5059 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5060 details about <var-name>.
5061
5062 Example:
5063 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5064
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005065
5066http-check comment <string>
5067 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5068 it fails.
5069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5070 yes | no | yes | yes
5071
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005072 Arguments :
5073 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5074 rule fails.
5075
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005076 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5077 user-friendly error reporting.
5078
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005079 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005080 "http-check expect".
5081
5082
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005083http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5084 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005085 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005086 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5088 yes | no | yes | yes
5089
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005090 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005091 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5092
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005093 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005094 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005095
5096 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5097 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5098 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5099 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5100
5101 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5102
5103 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5104
5105 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5106
5107 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5108
5109 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5110
5111 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5112 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5113 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5114 is used.
5115
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005116 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5117 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5118 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5119 haproxy -vv.
5120
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005121 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5122
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005123 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5124 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5125 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5126 different ports or with different servers.
5127
5128 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5129 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5130 the port with a "http-check connect".
5131
5132 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5133 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5134 do.
5135
5136 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5137 unset-var or comment rules.
5138
5139 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005140 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5141 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5142 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5143 option httpchk
5144
5145 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005146 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005147 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005148 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005149 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005150 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005151
5152 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5153
5154 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005155
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005156
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005157http-check disable-on-404
5158 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005160 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005161 Arguments : none
5162
5163 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5164 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5165 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5166 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5167 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5168 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5169 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5170 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005171 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5172 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005173 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5174 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5175 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005176
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005177 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005178
5179
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005180http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005181 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5182 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5183 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005184 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005186 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005187
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005188 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005189 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5190
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005191 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5192 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5193 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5194 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5195 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5196 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5197 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5198 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5199 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5200 result is always conclusive.
5201
5202 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5203 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5204 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005205 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5206 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005207 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5208 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005209 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5210 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5211 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005212
5213 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5214 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005215 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5216 supported :
5217 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5218 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005219 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5220 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5221 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5222 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5223 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005224
5225 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5226 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005227 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5228 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5229 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5230 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005231 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5232
5233 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5234 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5235 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5236 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5237
5238 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5239 informational message reported in logs if an error
5240 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5241 log-format string.
5242
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005243 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005244 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5245 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005246 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5247 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5248 details on the supported keywords.
5249
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005250 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5251 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5252 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5253 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005254
5255 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5256 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5257 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5258 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5259 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5260
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005261 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5262 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5263 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5264 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5265 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5266 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5267 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005268
5269 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005270 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005271 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5272 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5273 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5274 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5275
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005276 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5277 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005278 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5279 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5280 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5281 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5282 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5283 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5284 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5285 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005286 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5287 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5288 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5289 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5290 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5291 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5292 insensitive on the header names.
5293
5294 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5295 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5296 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5297 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5298 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5299 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005300
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005301 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005302 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005303 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5304 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5305 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5306 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5307 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005308 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005309 trace).
5310
5311 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005312 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005313 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5314 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5315 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5316 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5317 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005318 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005319
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005320 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5321 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5322 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5323 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5324 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5325 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5326
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005327 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005328 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005329 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5330 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5331 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5332 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5333 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5334 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5335
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005336 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5337 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5338 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5339 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5340 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005341
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005342 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5343 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5344
5345 Examples :
5346 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005347 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005348
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005349 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5350 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5351
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005352 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005353 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005354
5355 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005356 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005357
5358 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005359 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005360
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005361 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005362 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005363
5364
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005365http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005366 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5367 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005368 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5369 health checks.
5370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5371 yes | no | yes | yes
5372 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005373 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5374
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005375 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5376 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5377 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5378 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5379 to invent non-standard ones.
5380
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005381 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5382 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5383 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5384 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5385
5386 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5387 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5388 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5389 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005390
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005391 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005392 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005393 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005394 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5395 to add it.
5396
5397 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5398 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5399 to the log-format rules.
5400
5401 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5402 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5403 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005404
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005405 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5406 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5407 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5408 request.
5409
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005410 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5411 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5412 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005413 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5414 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5415 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5416 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005417 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005418
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005419 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005420 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5421 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005422
5423 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5424 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5425 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5426 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5427 configured request authority.
5428
5429 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5430 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005431
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005432 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005433
5434
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005435http-check send-state
5436 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5438 yes | no | yes | yes
5439 Arguments : none
5440
5441 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5442 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5443 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5444 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5445 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5446
5447 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5448 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5449 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5450 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5451 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005452 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5453 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5454 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5455
5456 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5457 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5458 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5459
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005460 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5461 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5462 checked in multiple backends.
5463
5464 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5465 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5466
5467 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5468 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5469 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5470 one fails.
5471
5472 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5473 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5474 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5475
5476 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5477 server's queue.
5478
5479 Example of a header received by the application server :
5480 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5481 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5482
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005483 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5484 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005485
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005486
5487http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005488 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005489 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5490 yes | no | yes | yes
5491
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005492 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005493 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5494 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5495 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5496 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5497 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5498 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5499 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5500 and '-'.
5501
5502 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5503
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005504 Examples :
5505 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005506
5507
5508http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005509 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005510 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5511 yes | no | yes | yes
5512
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005513 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005514 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5515 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5516 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5517 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5518 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5519 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5520 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5521 and '-'.
5522
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005523 Examples :
5524 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005525
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005526
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005527http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5528 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5529 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5530 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5531 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5533 yes | yes | yes | yes
5534 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005535 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005536 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005537 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005538 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005539
5540 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5541 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5542 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5543 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5544
5545 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5546 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5547 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5548 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5549
5550 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5551 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5552 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5553 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5554 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5555 chroot is performed.
5556
5557 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5558 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5559 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5560 considered.
5561
5562 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5563 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5564 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5565 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5566 considered as a raw string.
5567
5568 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5569 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5570 "content-type".
5571
5572 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5573 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5574 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5575 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5576 evaluated as a log-format string.
5577
5578 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5579 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5580 argument to "content-type".
5581
5582 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5583 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5584 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5585 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5586
5587 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5588 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5589 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5590 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5591 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5592 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5593 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5594 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5595
5596 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5597 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5598 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5599
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005600 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5601 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5602 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5603 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5604 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5605
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005606 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5607 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5608
5609
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005610http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005611 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5612
5613 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5614 no | yes | yes | yes
5615
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005616 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5617 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5618 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5619 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5620 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005621
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005622 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5623 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005624
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005625 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005626
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005627 Example:
5628 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5629 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5630 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005631
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005632 http-request allow if nagios
5633 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5634 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5635 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005636
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005637 Example:
5638 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5639 acl add path /addacl
5640 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005641
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005642 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005643
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005644 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5645 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005646
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005647 Example:
5648 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5649 acl setmap path /setmap
5650 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005651
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005652 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005653
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005654 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5655 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005656
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005657 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5658 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005659
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005660http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005661
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005662 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5663 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5664 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5665 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5666 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5667 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5668 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5669 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005670
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005671http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005672
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005673 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5674 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5675 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5676 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5677 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5678 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5679 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5680 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005681
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005682http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005683
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005684 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5685 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005686
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005687
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005688http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005689
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005690 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5691 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5692 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5693 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5694 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005695
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005696 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5697 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5698 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5699 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5700 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5701 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5702 instead.
5703
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005704 Example:
5705 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5706 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005707
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005708http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005709
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005710 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005711
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005712http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5713 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005714
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005715 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5716 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5717 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5718 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5719 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5720 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5721 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5722 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5723 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005724
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005725 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5726 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5727 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005728 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5729
5730 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5731 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5732 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5733 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005734
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005735http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005736
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005737 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5738 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5739 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5740 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5741 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5742 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005743
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005744http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005745
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005746 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5747 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5748 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5749 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5750 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005751
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005752http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005753
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005754 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5755 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5756 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5757 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5758 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5759 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005760
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005761http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5762http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5763 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5764 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5765 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5766 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005767
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005768 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5769 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5770 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005771 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005772 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5773 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5774 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005775 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005776 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005777
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005778http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5779 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5780 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5781 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5782
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005783http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5784
5785 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5786 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5787 pointed by <resolvers>.
5788 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5789 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5790 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5791 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5792 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5793 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5794 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5795 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5796 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5797 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5798 to 0.0.0.0.
5799
5800 Example:
5801 resolvers mydns
5802 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5803 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5804 timeout retry 1s
5805 hold valid 10s
5806 hold nx 3s
5807 hold other 3s
5808 hold obsolete 0s
5809 accepted_payload_size 8192
5810
5811 frontend fe
5812 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5813 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5814 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5815
5816 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5817 # which mean DNS resolution error
5818 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5819
5820 default_backend be
5821
5822 backend b_503
5823 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5824 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5825 # 503 error page to end users
5826
5827 backend be
5828 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5829 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5830 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5831 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5832 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5833
5834 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5835 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5836
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005837http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5838
5839 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5840 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5841 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5842 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005843 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5844 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005845
5846 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5847
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005848http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005849
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005850 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5851 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5852 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5853 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5854 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005855
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005856http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005857
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005858 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5859 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5860 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5861 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005862
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005863http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5864 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005865
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005866 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005867 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5868 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5869 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5870 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5871 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005872
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005873 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5874 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5875 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5876 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5877 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005878
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005879 Example:
5880 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5881
5882 # applied to:
5883 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5884
5885 # outputs:
5886 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5887
5888 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005889
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005890 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5891
5892 # applied to:
5893 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005894
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005895 # outputs:
5896 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005897
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005898http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5899 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5900
5901 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5902 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02005903 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
5904 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
5905 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005906
5907 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5908 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5909 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5910
5911 Example:
5912 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5913 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5914
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005915 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5916 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5917 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5918 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5919
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02005920http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5921 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5922
5923 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
5924 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
5925 query-string are replaced.
5926
5927 Example:
5928 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5929 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5930
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005931http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5932 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5933
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005934 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5935 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5936 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5937 against.
5938
5939 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5940 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5941 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005942
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005943 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5944 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5945 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5946 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5947 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5948 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5949 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5950 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5951 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005952 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5953 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005954
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005955 Example:
5956 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5957 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005958
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005959 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5960 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005961
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005962http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5963 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005964
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005965 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5966 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5967 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5968 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005969
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005970 Example:
5971 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005972
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005973 # applied to:
5974 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005975
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005976 # outputs:
5977 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005978
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005979http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5980 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5981 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005982 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005983 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5984
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005985 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005986 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5987 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005988 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005989 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005990 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005991 are followed to create the response :
5992
5993 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5994 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5995 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5996 ignored.
5997
5998 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5999 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006000 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006001 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6002 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006003
6004 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6005 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6006 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006007 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
6008 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006009
6010 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6011 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6012 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006013 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006014 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006015 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006016
6017 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6018 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6019 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6020 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6021 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6022 as a raw content.
6023
6024 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6025 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6026 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6027 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6028 considered as a raw string.
6029
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006030 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006031 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6032 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6033 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6034
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006035 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6036 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006037 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006038
6039 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6040
6041 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006042 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006043 if { path /ping }
6044
6045 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6046 if { path /favicon.ico }
6047
6048 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6049 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6050 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6051
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006052http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6053http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006054
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006055 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6056 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6057 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006058
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006059http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6060 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006061
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006062 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6063 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6064 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6065 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006066
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006067http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006068
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006069 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6070 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6071 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6072 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6073 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006074
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006075 Arguments:
6076 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6077 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006078
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006079 Example:
6080 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6081 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006082
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006083 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6084 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006085
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006086http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006087
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006088 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6089 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6090 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006091
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006092 Arguments:
6093 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6094 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006095
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006096 Example:
6097 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6098 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006099
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006100 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6101 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6102 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006103
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006104http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006105
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006106 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6107 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6108 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6109 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6110 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006111
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006112 Example:
6113 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6114 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6115 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6116 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6117 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6118 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6119 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6120 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6121 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006122
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006123http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006124
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006125 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6126 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6127 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6128 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6129 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006130
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006131http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6132 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006133
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006134 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6135 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6136 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6137 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6138 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6139 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6140 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6141 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6142 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006143
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006144http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006145
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006146 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6147 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6148 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6149 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6150 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6151 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6152 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006153
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006154http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006155
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006156 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6157 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6158 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006159
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006160http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006161
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006162 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6163 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6164 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6165 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6166 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6167 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6168 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6169 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006170
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006171http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006172
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006173 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6174 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6175 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6176 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6177 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6178 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006179
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006180 Example :
6181 # prepend the host name before the path
6182 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006183
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006184http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6185
6186 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6187 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6188 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6189
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006190http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006191
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006192 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6193 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6194 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6195 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6196 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006197
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006198http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006199
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006200 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6201 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6202 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6203 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6204 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6205 values have higher priority.
6206 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6207 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6208 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6209 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6210 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006211
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006212http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006213
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006214 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6215 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6216 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6217 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6218 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6219 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6220 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006221
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006222 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006223
6224 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006225 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6226 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006227
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006228http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6229 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6230 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6231 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006232 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6233 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006234
6235 Arguments :
6236 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6237 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006238
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006239 See also "option forwardfor".
6240
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006241 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006242 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6243 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6244
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006245 # After the masking this will track connections
6246 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6247 http-request track-sc0 src
6248
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006249 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6250 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6251
6252http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6253
6254 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6255 expression.
6256
6257 Arguments:
6258 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6259 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006260
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006261 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006262 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6263 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6264
6265 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6266 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6267 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6268
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006269http-request set-timeout server|tunnel { <timeout> | <expr> }
6270 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6271
6272 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6273 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6274 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6275 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6276 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6277
6278 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6279 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6280 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6281 results.
6282
6283 Example:
6284 http-request set-timeout server 5s
6285 http-request set-timeout hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
6286
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006287http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6288
6289 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6290 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6291 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6292 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6293 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6294 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6295 information from the request.
6296
6297 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6298
6299http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6300
6301 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6302 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6303 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6304 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6305 path and the query string.
6306 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6307
6308http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6309
6310 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6311 inline.
6312
6313 Arguments:
6314 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6315 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6316 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6317 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6318 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6319 (request and response)
6320 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6321 processing
6322 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6323 processing
6324 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6325 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6326 and '_'.
6327
6328 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6329 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006330
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006331 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006332 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006333
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006334http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6335 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006336
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006337 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6338 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6339 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6340 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6341 agent name must be used.
6342
6343 Arguments:
6344 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6345
6346 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6347 configuration.
6348
6349http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6350
6351 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6352 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6353 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6354 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6355 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6356 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6357 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6358 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6359 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6360 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6361 action.
6362 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6363 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6364 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6365 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6366 you fully understand how it works.
6367
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006368http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6369
6370 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6371 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6372 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6373 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6374 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006375 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006376 processing.
6377
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006378 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006379 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6380 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6381 rules evaluation.
6382
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006383http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6384http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6385 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6386 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6387 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6388 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006389
6390 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6391 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6392 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006393 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6394 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6395 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6396 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6397 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6398 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6399 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6400 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6401 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6402 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006403 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006404 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6405 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6406 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6407 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6408 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006409
6410http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6411http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6412http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6413
6414 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6415 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6416 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6417 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006418 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006419 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6420 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6421 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6422 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6423 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6424 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6425 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6426
6427 Arguments :
6428 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6429 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6430 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6431 select which table entry to update the counters.
6432
6433 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6434 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6435 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6436 that table until the session ends.
6437
6438 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6439 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6440 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6441 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6442 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6443 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6444 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6445 useful information.
6446
6447 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6448 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6449 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6450 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6451 checks that make use of it.
6452
6453http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6454
6455 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006456
6457 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006458 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006459
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006460http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6461
6462 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6463 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6464 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6465 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6466 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6467 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6468
6469 Arguments :
6470 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6471
6472 Example:
6473 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6474
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006475http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006476
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006477 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6478 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6479 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006480
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006481
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006482http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006483 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6484
6485 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6486 no | yes | yes | yes
6487
6488 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6489 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6490 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6491 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6492 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6493 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6494
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006495 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6496 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006497
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006498 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006499
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006500 Example:
6501 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006502
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006503 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006504
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006505 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6506 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006507
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006508 Example:
6509 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006510
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006511 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006512
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006513 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6514 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006515
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006516 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6517 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006518
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006519http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006520
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006521 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6522 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6523 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6524 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6525 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6526 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6527 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6528 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006529
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006530http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006531
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006532 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6533 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6534 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6535 example, or to pass some internal information.
6536 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6537 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6538 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006539
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006540http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006541
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006542 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6543 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006544
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006545http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006546
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006547 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006548
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006549http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006550
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006551 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6552 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6553 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6554 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6555 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6556 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6557 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006558
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006559 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6560 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6561 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6562 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6563 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006564
6565 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6566 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6567 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6568 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006569
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006570http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006571
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006572 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6573 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6574 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6575 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6576 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6577 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006578
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006579http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006580
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006581 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6582 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6583 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6584 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6585 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006586
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006587http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006588
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006589 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6590 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6591 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6592 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6593 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6594 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006595
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006596http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6597http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6598 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6599 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6600 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6601 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006602
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006603 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6604 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6605 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006606 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006607 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6608 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6609 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006610 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006611 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006612
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006613http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006614
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006615 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6616 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6617 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6618 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6619 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6620 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006621
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006622http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6623 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006624
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006625 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6626 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006627
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006628 Example:
6629 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006630
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006631 # applied to:
6632 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006633
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006634 # outputs:
6635 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006636
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006637 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006638
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006639http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6640 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006641
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006642 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006643 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006644
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006645 Example:
6646 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006647
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006648 # applied to:
6649 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006650
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006651 # outputs:
6652 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006653
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006654http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6655 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6656 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006657 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006658 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6659
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006660 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006661 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6662 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006663 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006664 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006665 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006666 are followed to create the response :
6667
6668 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6669 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6670 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6671 ignored.
6672
6673 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6674 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006675 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006676 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6677 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006678
6679 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6680 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6681 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006682 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
6683 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006684
6685 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6686 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6687 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006688 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006689 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006690 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006691
6692 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6693 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6694 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6695 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6696 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6697 as a raw content.
6698
6699 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6700 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6701 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6702 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6703 considered as a raw string.
6704
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006705 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6706 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6707 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6708 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6709
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006710 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6711 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006712 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006713
6714 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6715
6716 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006717 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006718 if { status eq 404 }
6719
6720 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6721 string "This is the end !" \
6722 if { status eq 500 }
6723
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006724http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6725http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006726
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006727 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6728 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6729 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006730
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006731http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6732 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006733
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006734 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6735 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6736 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6737 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006738
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006739http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006740
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006741 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6742 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6743 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6744 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6745 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006746
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006747 Arguments:
6748 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006749
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006750 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6751 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006752
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006753http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006754
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006755 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6756 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6757 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006758
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006759http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6760
6761 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6762 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6763 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6764 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6765 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6766
6767http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6768
6769 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6770 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6771 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6772 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6773 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6774 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6775 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6776 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6777 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6778
6779http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6780
6781 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6782 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6783 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6784 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6785 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6786 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6787 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6788
6789http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6790
6791 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6792 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6793 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6794 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6795 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6796 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6797 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6798 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6799
6800http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6801 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6802
6803 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6804 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6805 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6806 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006807
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006808 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006809 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6810 http-response set-status 431
6811 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6812 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006813
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006814http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006815
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006816 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6817 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6818 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6819 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6820 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6821 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6822 based on some information from the request.
6823
6824 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6825
6826http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6827
6828 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6829 inline.
6830
6831 Arguments:
6832 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6833 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6834 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6835 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6836 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6837 (request and response)
6838 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6839 processing
6840 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6841 processing
6842 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6843 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6844 and '_'.
6845
6846 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6847 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006848
6849 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006850 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006851
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006852http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006853
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006854 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6855 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6856 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6857 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6858 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6859 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6860 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6861 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6862 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6863 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6864 action.
6865 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6866 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6867 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6868 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6869 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006870
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006871http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6872
6873 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6874 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6875 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6876 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6877 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006878 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006879 processing.
6880
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006881 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006882 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006883 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006884 rules evaluation.
6885
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006886http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6887http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6888http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006889
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006890 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6891 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6892 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6893 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6894 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6895 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6896
6897http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6898
6899 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6900 about <var-name>.
6901
6902 Example:
6903 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6904
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006905
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006906http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6907 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6908
6909 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6910 yes | no | yes | yes
6911
6912 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006913 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6914 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6915 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006916
6917 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6918
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006919 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6920 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6921 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6922 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6923 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6924 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6925 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6926 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6927 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6928 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006929
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006930 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6931 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6932 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6933 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6934 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6935 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6936 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02006937 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
6938 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
6939 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
6940 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
6941 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
6942 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006943
6944 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6945 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6946 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6947 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6948 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6949 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6950 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6951 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006952 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006953 downsides of rare connection failures.
6954
6955 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6956 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6957 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6958 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6959 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6960 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006961 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006962 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6963 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6964 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6965 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6966 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6967
6968 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006969 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6970 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6971 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006972
Amaury Denoyelle7239c242020-10-15 16:41:09 +02006973 - connections sent to a server with a variable value as TLS SNI extension
6974 are marked private and are never shared. This is not the case if the SNI
6975 is guaranteed to be a constant, as for example using a literal string;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006976
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006977 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6978 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006979
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006980 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006981
6982 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6983 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6984 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6985
6986 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6987
6988
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006989http-send-name-header [<header>]
6990 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006991 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6992 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006993 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006994 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6995
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006996 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6997 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6998 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6999 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7000 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7001 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7002 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7003 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7004 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7005 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7006 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7007 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7008 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7009 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7010 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7011 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007012
7013 See also : "server"
7014
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007015id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007016 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7018 no | yes | yes | yes
7019 Arguments : none
7020
7021 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7022 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7023 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007024
7025
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007026ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7027 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7028 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007029 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007030
7031 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7032 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7033 and running).
7034
7035 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7036 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7037 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007038 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007039 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7040
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007041 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7042 "unless" condition is met.
7043
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007044 Example:
7045 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7046 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7047 ignore-persist if url_static
7048
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007049 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7050
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007051load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7052 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7053 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7054 yes | no | yes | yes
7055
7056 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7057 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7058 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007059 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007060 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
7061 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7062 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7063 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7064
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007065 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007066 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007067 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007068
7069 Arguments:
7070 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7071 named "server-state-file".
7072
7073 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7074 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7075 name is used as a file name.
7076
7077 none don't load any stat for this backend
7078
7079 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007080 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7081 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7082 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007083 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007084 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007085
7086 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7087 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7088
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007089 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007090
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007091 global
7092 stats socket /tmp/socket
7093 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007094
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007095 defaults
7096 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007097
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007098 backend bk
7099 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7100 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007101
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007102
7103 Then one can run :
7104
7105 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7106
7107 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7108
7109 1
7110 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7111 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7112 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7113
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007114 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007115
7116 global
7117 stats socket /tmp/socket
7118 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7119
7120 defaults
7121 load-server-state-from-file local
7122
7123 backend bk
7124 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7125 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7126
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007127
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007128 Then one can run :
7129
7130 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7131
7132 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7133
7134 1
7135 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7136 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7137 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7138
7139 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7140 "show servers state"
7141
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007142
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007143log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007144log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007145 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007146no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007147 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7149 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007150
7151 Prefix :
7152 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7153 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7154 prefix does not allow arguments.
7155
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007156 Arguments :
7157 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7158 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7159 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7160 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7161 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7162 parameter.
7163
7164 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7165 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7166
7167 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7168 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7169 standard syslog port).
7170
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007171 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7172 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7173 standard syslog port).
7174
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007175 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7176 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7177 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007178 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007179
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007180 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7181 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7182 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7183 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7184 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7185 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7186 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7187 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7188 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7189 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7190 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7191 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
7192 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
7193 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7194 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7195 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007196 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7197 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007198
7199 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7200 and "fd@2", see above.
7201
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007202 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7203 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7204 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7205 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7206 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7207 having the logs instantly available.
7208
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007209 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7210 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007211
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007212 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7213 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7214 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7215 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7216 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7217 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7218 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7219 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7220 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7221 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007222 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007223
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007224 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7225 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7226 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7227 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7228 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7229
7230 <sample_size>
7231 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7232 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7233 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7234 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7235 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7236
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007237 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7238 one of the following :
7239
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007240 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7241 field is stripped. This is the default.
7242 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7243 rfc3164.
7244
7245 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007246 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7247
7248 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7249 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7250
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007251 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7252 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7253 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7254 designed to be used with a local log server.
7255
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007256 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7257 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7258 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7259 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7260 systemd logger consumes.
7261
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007262 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7263 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7264 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7265 used with a local log server.
7266
7267 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7268 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7269 designed to be used with a local log server.
7270
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007271 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7272 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7273 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7274 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7275
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007276 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7277
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007278 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7279 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7280 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7281
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007282 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7283 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7284 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7285 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007286
7287 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7288 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7289 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007290 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7291 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7292 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7293 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7294 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007295
7296 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7297
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007298 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7299 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7300 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007301
7302 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7303 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7304 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7305 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7306
7307 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7308 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007309
7310 Example :
7311 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007312 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7313 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7314 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007315 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
7316 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007317 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007318
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007319
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007320log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007321 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7322 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7323 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007324
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007325 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7326 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7327 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7328 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7329 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007330
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007331 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7332 "option httplog" directives.
7333
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007334log-format-sd <string>
7335 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7336 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7337 yes | yes | yes | no
7338
7339 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7340 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7341 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7342 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7343 which covers the log format string in depth.
7344
7345 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7346 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7347
7348 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7349 log format to "rfc5424".
7350
7351 Example :
7352 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7353
7354
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007355log-tag <string>
7356 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7357 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7358 yes | yes | yes | yes
7359
7360 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7361 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7362 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7363 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7364 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7365 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7366 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7367 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7368 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007369
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007370max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7371 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7372 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7373 yes | no | yes | yes
7374
7375 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7376 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7377 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7378 servers.
7379
7380 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7381 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7382 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7383 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7384 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007385 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007386 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7387 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7388 picking a different server.
7389
7390 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7391 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7392 even if they have to be queued.
7393
7394 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7395 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7396
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007397max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7398 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7399 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7400 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007401
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007402maxconn <conns>
7403 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7405 yes | yes | yes | no
7406 Arguments :
7407 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7408 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7409 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7410 closes.
7411
7412 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7413 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7414 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7415 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007416 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7417 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7418 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7419 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007420
7421 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7422 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7423 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7424
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007425 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7426 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007427
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007428 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7429
7430
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007431mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007432 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7434 yes | yes | yes | yes
7435 Arguments :
7436 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7437 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7438 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7439 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7440
7441 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7442 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7443 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7444 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7445 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7446
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007447 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7448 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7449 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007450
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007451 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007452 defaults http_instances
7453 mode http
7454
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007455
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007456monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007457 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7459 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007460 Arguments :
7461 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7462 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007463 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007464 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7465 backend and its backup.
7466
7467 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7468 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7469 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7470 servers in a list of backends.
7471
7472 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7473 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7474 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7475 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7476 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7477 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7478 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007479 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7480 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007481
7482 Example:
7483 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007484 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007485 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7486 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7487 monitor-uri /site_alive
7488 monitor fail if site_dead
7489
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007490 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007491
7492
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007493monitor-uri <uri>
7494 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7496 yes | yes | yes | no
7497 Arguments :
7498 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7499 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7500
7501 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7502 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7503 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7504 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7505 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7506 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7507 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7508 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7509
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007510 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007511 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7512 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7513 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7514 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7515 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7516 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007517
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007518 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7519 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7520 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7521 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7522
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007523 Example :
7524 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7525 frontend www
7526 mode http
7527 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7528
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007529 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007530
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007531
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007532option abortonclose
7533no option abortonclose
7534 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7536 yes | no | yes | yes
7537 Arguments : none
7538
7539 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7540 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7541 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7542 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007543 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007544 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7545 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7546 encountered while delivering the response.
7547
7548 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7549 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7550 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7551 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7552 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7553 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007554 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007555 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007556 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007557 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7558 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7559 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7560
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007561 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7562 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007563 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7564 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7565 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7566 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7567 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7568 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007569 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007570
7571 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7572 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7573
7574 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7575
7576
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007577option accept-invalid-http-request
7578no option accept-invalid-http-request
7579 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7581 yes | yes | yes | no
7582 Arguments : none
7583
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007584 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007585 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007586 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007587 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7588 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7589 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7590 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7591 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007592 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7593 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7594 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7595 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007596 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007597 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007598 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7599 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7600 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007601
7602 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7603 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7604 been confirmed.
7605
7606 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7607 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007608 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7609 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007610 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7611
7612 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7613 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7614
7615 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7616 stats socket.
7617
7618
7619option accept-invalid-http-response
7620no option accept-invalid-http-response
7621 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7623 yes | no | yes | yes
7624 Arguments : none
7625
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007626 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007627 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007628 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007629 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7630 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7631 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7632 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7633 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007634 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7635 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7636 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007637
7638 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7639 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7640 been confirmed.
7641
7642 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7643 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7644 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7645 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7646
7647 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7648 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7649
7650 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7651 stats socket.
7652
7653
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007654option allbackups
7655no option allbackups
7656 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7658 yes | no | yes | yes
7659 Arguments : none
7660
7661 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7662 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7663 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7664 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7665 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7666 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7667 order between the backup servers anymore.
7668
7669 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7670 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7671
7672 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7673 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7674
7675
7676option checkcache
7677no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007678 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7680 yes | no | yes | yes
7681 Arguments : none
7682
7683 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7684 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007685 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007686 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7687 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007688 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007689
7690 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007691 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007692 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007693 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7694 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007695 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007696 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007697 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7698 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007699 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007700 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7701 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007702 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007703 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7704 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7705 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7706 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7707 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7708 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7709 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7710 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7711 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7712
7713 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007714 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7715 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7716 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7717 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007718
7719 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7720 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007721 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007722 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007723
7724 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7725 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7726
7727
7728option clitcpka
7729no option clitcpka
7730 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7732 yes | yes | yes | no
7733 Arguments : none
7734
7735 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7736 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007737 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007738 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7739
7740 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7741 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7742 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7743 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7744
7745 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7746 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7747 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7748 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7749 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7750
7751 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7752
7753 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7754 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7755 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7756
7757 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7758 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7759
7760 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7761
7762
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007763option contstats
7764 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7766 yes | yes | yes | no
7767 Arguments : none
7768
7769 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7770 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7771 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7772 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007773 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7774 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7775 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7776 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7777 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007778
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007779option disable-h2-upgrade
7780no option disable-h2-upgrade
7781 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7782 connection.
7783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7784 yes | yes | yes | no
7785 Arguments : none
7786
7787 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7788 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7789 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7790 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7791 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7792 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7793 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7794 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7795
7796 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7797 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007798
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007799option dontlog-normal
7800no option dontlog-normal
7801 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7803 yes | yes | yes | no
7804 Arguments : none
7805
7806 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7807 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7808 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7809 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7810 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7811 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7812 logged.
7813
7814 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7815 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7816 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7817
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007818 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007819 logging.
7820
7821
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007822option dontlognull
7823no option dontlognull
7824 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7826 yes | yes | yes | no
7827 Arguments : none
7828
7829 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7830 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7831 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7832 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7833 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7834 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007835 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7836 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7837 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007838
7839 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007840 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007841 would not be logged.
7842
7843 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7844 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7845
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007846 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007847 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007848
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007849
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007850option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007851 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7853 yes | yes | yes | yes
7854 Arguments :
7855 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7856 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007857 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007858 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007859
7860 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7861 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7862 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7863 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7864 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7865 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7866 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007867 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7868 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7869 possible that the client has already brought one.
7870
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007871 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007872 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007873 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007874 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007875 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007876 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007877
7878 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7879 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7880 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7881 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7882 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7883 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7884 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7885
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007886 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7887 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7888 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7889 are under the control of the end-user.
7890
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007891 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007892 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7893 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007894 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7895 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7896 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007897
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007898 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007899 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7900 frontend www
7901 mode http
7902 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7903
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007904 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7905 backend www
7906 mode http
7907 option forwardfor header X-Client
7908
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007909 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007910 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007911
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007912
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007913option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7914no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7915 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7917 yes | yes | yes | no
7918 Arguments : none
7919
7920 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7921 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7922 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7923 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7924 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7925 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7926 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7927
7928 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7929 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7930 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7931 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7932 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7933 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7934 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7935 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7936 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7937 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7938
7939 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7940
7941 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7942 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7943
7944 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7945 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7946
7947
7948option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7949no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7950 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7952 yes | no | yes | yes
7953 Arguments : none
7954
7955 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7956 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7957 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7958 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7959 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7960 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7961 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7962
7963 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7964 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7965 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7966 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7967 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7968 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7969 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7970 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7971 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7972 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7973
7974 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7975
7976 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7977 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7978
7979 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7980 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7981
7982
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007983option http-buffer-request
7984no option http-buffer-request
7985 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7987 yes | yes | yes | yes
7988 Arguments : none
7989
7990 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7991 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7992 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7993 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7994 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7995 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007996 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7997 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7998 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7999 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008000
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01008001 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008002
8003
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008004option http-ignore-probes
8005no option http-ignore-probes
8006 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8008 yes | yes | yes | no
8009 Arguments : none
8010
8011 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8012 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8013 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8014 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8015 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8016 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8017 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8018 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8019 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008020 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8021 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008022 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8023
8024 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8025 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8026 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8027 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8028 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8029 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8030 are often the only way to detect them.
8031
8032 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8033 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8034
8035 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8036
8037
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008038option http-keep-alive
8039no option http-keep-alive
8040 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8042 yes | yes | yes | yes
8043 Arguments : none
8044
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008045 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8046 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008047 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8048 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008049 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8050 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8051 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008052
8053 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8054 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008055 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8056 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8057 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8058 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8059 situations where this option may be useful :
8060
8061 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008062 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008063
8064 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8065 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8066
8067 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8068 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8069 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8070 request.
8071
8072 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8073 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008074 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8075 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8076 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008077
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008078 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8079 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8080 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8081 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8082 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8083 not set.
8084
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008085 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8086 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8087 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008088
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008089 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008090 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008091 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008092
8093
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008094option http-no-delay
8095no option http-no-delay
8096 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8098 yes | yes | yes | yes
8099 Arguments : none
8100
8101 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8102 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8103 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8104 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8105 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8106 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8107 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
8108 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
8109 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8110 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8111 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8112 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8113 affected.
8114
8115 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8116 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8117 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8118 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8119 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8120 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8121 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8122 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8123 latency environments.
8124
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008125 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8126
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008127
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008128option http-pretend-keepalive
8129no option http-pretend-keepalive
8130 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
8131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008132 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008133 Arguments : none
8134
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008135 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008136 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8137 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8138 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
8139 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
8140 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8141 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8142 consider the response complete.
8143
8144 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
8145 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
8146 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
8147 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008148 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008149 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8150
8151 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8152 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8153 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8154 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
8155 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
8156 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
8157 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8158
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008159 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8160 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8161 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8162 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8163 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8164 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008165
8166 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8167 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8168
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008169 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008170 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008171
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008172
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008173option http-server-close
8174no option http-server-close
8175 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8177 yes | yes | yes | yes
8178 Arguments : none
8179
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008180 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8181 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8182 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8183 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008184 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8185 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8186 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8187 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8188 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8189 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8190 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8191 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8192 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8193 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8194 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008195
8196 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8197 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8198 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8199 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008200 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8201 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008202
8203 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8204 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008205 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8206 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8207 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008208
8209 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8210 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8211
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008212 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8213 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008214
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008215option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008216no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008217 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8219 yes | yes | yes | no
8220 Arguments : none
8221
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008222 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008223 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8224 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8225 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8226 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8227 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
8228 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
8229
8230 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
8231 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008232 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8233 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8234 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008235
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008236 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8237 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8238 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8239 front of an existing proxy.
8240
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008241 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8242
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008243 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008244
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008245option httpchk
8246option httpchk <uri>
8247option httpchk <method> <uri>
8248option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008249 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8251 yes | no | yes | yes
8252 Arguments :
8253 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8254 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8255 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8256 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8257 ones.
8258
8259 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8260 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8261 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8262
8263 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8264 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8265 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008266 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008267
8268 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8269 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8270 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8271 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8272 the lack of any response.
8273
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008274 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8275 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8276 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8277 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8278
8279 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8280 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8281 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008282
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008283 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8284 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008285 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008286 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008287 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008288
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008289 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8290 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8291 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8292 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8293
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008294 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008295 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8296 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8297 backend https_relay
8298 mode tcp
8299 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8300 http-check send hdr Host www
8301 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008302
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008303 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8304 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8305 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008306
8307
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008308option httpclose
8309no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008310 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8312 yes | yes | yes | yes
8313 Arguments : none
8314
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008315 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8316 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8317 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8318 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008319 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008320
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008321 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8322 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008323 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008324 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8325 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008326
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008327 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8328 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8329 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008330
8331 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8332 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008333 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8334 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8335 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008336
8337 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8338 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8339
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008340 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008341
8342
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008343option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008344 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008346 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008347 Arguments :
8348 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8349 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8350 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008351 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008352 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008353
8354 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8355 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8356 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8357 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8358 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8359 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8360 ports.
8361
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008362 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8363 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008364
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008365 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8366
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008367 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008368
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008369
8370option http_proxy
8371no option http_proxy
8372 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8374 yes | yes | yes | yes
8375 Arguments : none
8376
8377 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8378 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8379 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8380 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8381 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8382
8383 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8384 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008385 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8386 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008387
8388 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8389 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8390
8391 Example :
8392 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8393 backend direct_forward
8394 option httpclose
8395 option http_proxy
8396
8397 See also : "option httpclose"
8398
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008399
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008400option independent-streams
8401no option independent-streams
8402 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8404 yes | yes | yes | yes
8405 Arguments : none
8406
8407 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8408 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8409 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8410 receive data or not.
8411
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008412 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008413 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8414 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8415 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8416 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8417 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8418 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8419 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8420 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8421 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8422 socket buffers.
8423
8424 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8425 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8426 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8427 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8428 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8429
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008430 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008431
8432
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008433option ldap-check
8434 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8436 yes | no | yes | yes
8437 Arguments : none
8438
8439 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8440 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8441 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8442 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8443
8444 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8445 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8446
8447 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8448 configure it.
8449
8450 Example :
8451 option ldap-check
8452
8453 See also : "option httpchk"
8454
8455
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008456option external-check
8457 Use external processes for server health checks
8458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8459 yes | no | yes | yes
8460
8461 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8462 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8463 command".
8464
8465 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8466
8467 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8468
8469
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008470option log-health-checks
8471no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008472 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8474 yes | no | yes | yes
8475 Arguments : none
8476
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008477 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8478 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8479 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008480
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008481 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8482 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8483 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8484 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8485 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8486
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008487 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008488 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008489
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008490 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8491 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8492 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008493
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008494
8495option log-separate-errors
8496no option log-separate-errors
8497 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8499 yes | yes | yes | no
8500 Arguments : none
8501
8502 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8503 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8504 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8505 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8506 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8507 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8508 provides very important information.
8509
8510 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8511 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8512 error logs.
8513
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008514 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008515 logging.
8516
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008517
8518option logasap
8519no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008520 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8522 yes | yes | yes | no
8523 Arguments : none
8524
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008525 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8526 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8527 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8528 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8529
8530 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8531 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8532 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8533 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8534 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008535 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008536 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8537 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8538 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8539 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008540 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008541
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008542 Examples :
8543 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8544 mode http
8545 option httplog
8546 option logasap
8547 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8548
8549 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8550 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8551 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8552 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8553
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008554 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008555 logging.
8556
8557
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008558option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008559 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8561 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008562 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008563 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8564 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008565 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8566 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008567
8568 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8569 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008570 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008571 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8572 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8573 in the MySQL table, like this :
8574
8575 USE mysql;
8576 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8577 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8578
8579 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008580 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008581 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8582 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8583 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8584 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8585 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8586 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8587 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8588
8589 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8590 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008591
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008592 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008593
8594 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8595 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8596 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8597 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008598 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8599 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008600
8601 See also: "option httpchk"
8602
8603
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008604option nolinger
8605no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008606 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008607 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8608 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008609 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008610
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008611 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008612 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8613 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8614 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8615 connections.
8616
8617 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8618 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008619 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
8620 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
8621 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
8622 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
8623 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
8624 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
8625 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
8626 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
8627 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
8628 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
8629 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
8630 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
8631 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008632
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008633 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
8634 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
8635 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
8636 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
8637 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008638
8639 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8640 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008641 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05008642 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008643 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008644
8645 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8646 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8647
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008648 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
8649 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008650
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008651option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8652 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8654 yes | yes | yes | yes
8655 Arguments :
8656 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8657 matching <network>
8658 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8659 header name.
8660
8661 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8662 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8663 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8664 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8665 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8666 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8667 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8668 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8669 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8670 possible that the client has already brought one.
8671
8672 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8673 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8674 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8675 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8676 header and requires different one.
8677
8678 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8679 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8680 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8681 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8682 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8683 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8684 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8685
8686 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8687 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8688 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8689 both are defined.
8690
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008691 Examples :
8692 # Original Destination address
8693 frontend www
8694 mode http
8695 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8696
8697 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8698 backend www
8699 mode http
8700 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8701
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008702 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008703
8704
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008705option persist
8706no option persist
8707 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8708 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8709 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008710 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008711
8712 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8713 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8714 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8715 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8716 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8717 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8718 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8719 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8720 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8721 redirected to another valid server.
8722
8723 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8724 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8725
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008726 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008727
8728
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008729option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8730 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8732 yes | no | yes | yes
8733 Arguments :
8734 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8735 PostgreSQL server.
8736
8737 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8738 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8739 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8740 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8741
8742 See also: "option httpchk"
8743
8744
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008745option prefer-last-server
8746no option prefer-last-server
8747 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8748 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8749 yes | no | yes | yes
8750 Arguments : none
8751
8752 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8753 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8754 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8755 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8756 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8757 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8758 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8759 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8760 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008761 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8762 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008763 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8764 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8765 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008766 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8767 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8768 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008769
8770 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8771 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8772
8773 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8774
8775
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008776option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008777option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008778no option redispatch
8779 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8780 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8781 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008782 Arguments :
8783 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8784 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8785 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008786 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008787 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008788 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008789 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8790 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8791 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8792
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008793
8794 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8795 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8796 be able to access the service anymore.
8797
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008798 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8799 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008800
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008801 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8802 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8803 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8804 following order:
8805
8806 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8807
8808 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8809 list, or
8810
8811 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8812
8813 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8814 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8815
8816 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8817 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8818 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8819 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8820
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008821 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008822 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8823 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008824
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008825 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8826 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8827
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008828 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008829
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008830
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008831option redis-check
8832 Use redis health checks for server testing
8833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8834 yes | no | yes | yes
8835 Arguments : none
8836
8837 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8838 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8839 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8840 find the "+PONG" response message.
8841
8842 Example :
8843 option redis-check
8844
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008845 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008846
8847
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008848option smtpchk
8849option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8850 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8852 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008853 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008854 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008855 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008856 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8857
8858 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8859 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8860 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8861
8862 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8863 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8864 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8865 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8866 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8867 dead server.
8868
8869 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8870 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008871 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008872 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8873
8874 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8875 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8876 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8877 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008878 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008879
8880 Example :
8881 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8882
8883 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8884
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008885
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008886option socket-stats
8887no option socket-stats
8888
8889 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8891 yes | yes | yes | no
8892
8893 Arguments : none
8894
8895
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008896option splice-auto
8897no option splice-auto
8898 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8900 yes | yes | yes | yes
8901 Arguments : none
8902
8903 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8904 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008905 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008906 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008907 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008908 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8909 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8910 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8911 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8912
8913 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8914 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8915 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8916 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8917 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8918 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8919 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8920 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8921 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8922 keyword.
8923
8924 Example :
8925 option splice-auto
8926
8927 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8928 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8929
8930 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8931 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8932
8933
8934option splice-request
8935no option splice-request
8936 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8938 yes | yes | yes | yes
8939 Arguments : none
8940
8941 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008942 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008943 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8944 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8945 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8946 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8947
8948 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8949
8950 Example :
8951 option splice-request
8952
8953 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8954 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8955
8956 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8957 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8958
8959
8960option splice-response
8961no option splice-response
8962 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8964 yes | yes | yes | yes
8965 Arguments : none
8966
8967 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008968 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008969 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8970 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8971 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8972 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8973
8974 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8975
8976 Example :
8977 option splice-response
8978
8979 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8980 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8981
8982 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8983 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8984
8985
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008986option spop-check
8987 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8989 no | no | no | yes
8990 Arguments : none
8991
8992 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8993 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8994 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8995 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8996
8997 Example :
8998 option spop-check
8999
9000 See also : "option httpchk"
9001
9002
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009003option srvtcpka
9004no option srvtcpka
9005 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9007 yes | no | yes | yes
9008 Arguments : none
9009
9010 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9011 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009012 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009013 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9014
9015 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9016 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9017 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9018 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9019
9020 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9021 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9022 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9023 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9024 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9025
9026 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9027
9028 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9029 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9030 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9031
9032 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9033 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9034
9035 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9036
9037
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009038option ssl-hello-chk
9039 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9041 yes | no | yes | yes
9042 Arguments : none
9043
9044 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9045 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9046 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9047 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9048 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9049 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9050 hello message.
9051
9052 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9053 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9054 messages, which is appreciable.
9055
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009056 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
9057 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9058 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009059
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009060 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9061
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009062
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009063option tcp-check
9064 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9065 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9066 yes | no | yes | yes
9067
9068 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9069 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9070
9071 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9072 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9073 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9074
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009075 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009076 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9077 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9078 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9079 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9080 only.
9081
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009082 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009083 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
9084 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9085 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9086 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9087
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009088 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009089 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9090 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009091 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009092 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9093 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9094 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9095 the respective protocols.
9096 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009097 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009098
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009099 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009100
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009101 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9102 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9103 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9104 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009105
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009106 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9107 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9108 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009109
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009110
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009111 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009112 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009113 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009114 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009115
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009116 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009117 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009118 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009119
9120 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9121 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009122 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009123 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009124 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009125 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009126 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009127 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009128 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9129 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009130 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009131 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9132 tcp-check expect string +OK
9133
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009134 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009135 (send many headers before analyzing)
9136 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009137 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009138 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9139 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9140 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9141 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009142 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009143
9144
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009145 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009146
9147
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009148option tcp-smart-accept
9149no option tcp-smart-accept
9150 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9152 yes | yes | yes | no
9153 Arguments : none
9154
9155 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9156 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9157 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9158 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9159 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9160 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9161
9162 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9163 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9164 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9165 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9166
9167 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9168 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9169 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009170 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009171
9172 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9173 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9174 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9175
9176 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9177 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9178 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9179
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009180 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9181
9182
9183option tcp-smart-connect
9184no option tcp-smart-connect
9185 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9187 yes | no | yes | yes
9188 Arguments : none
9189
9190 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9191 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9192 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9193 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9194 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9195
9196 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9197 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9198 complex.
9199
9200 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9201 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9202 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9203
9204 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9205 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9206
9207 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9208
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009209
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009210option tcpka
9211 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9213 yes | yes | yes | yes
9214 Arguments : none
9215
9216 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9217 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009218 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009219 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9220
9221 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9222 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9223 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9224 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9225
9226 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9227 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9228 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9229 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9230 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9231
9232 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9233
9234 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9235 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9236 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9237 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9238 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9239 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9240 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9241 backends.
9242
9243 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9244
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009245
9246option tcplog
9247 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009249 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009250 Arguments : none
9251
9252 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9253 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9254 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9255 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9256 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9257 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9258 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9259 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9260
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009261 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009263 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009264
9265
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009266option transparent
9267no option transparent
9268 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009270 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009271 Arguments : none
9272
9273 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9274 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9275 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9276 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9277 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9278 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9279 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9280 appropriate server.
9281
9282 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9283 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9284
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009285 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009286 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009287
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009288
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009289external-check command <command>
9290 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9292 yes | no | yes | yes
9293
9294 Arguments :
9295 <command> is the external command to run
9296
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009297 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9298
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009299 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009300
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009301 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9302 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9303 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9304 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9305 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9306 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009307
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009308 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9309
9310 Environment variables :
9311 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9312 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9313
9314 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9315
9316 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9317
9318 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9319 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9320 for a UNIX socket).
9321
9322 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9323
9324 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9325
9326 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9327
9328 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9329
9330 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9331
9332 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9333 socket).
9334
9335 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9336 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9337
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009338 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9339
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009340 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9341 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9342 failed.
9343
9344 Example :
9345 external-check command /bin/true
9346
9347 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9348
9349
9350external-check path <path>
9351 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9353 yes | no | yes | yes
9354
9355 Arguments :
9356 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9357
9358 The default path is "".
9359
9360 Example :
9361 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9362
9363 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9364 "external-check command"
9365
9366
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009367persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009368persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009369 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9371 yes | no | yes | yes
9372 Arguments :
9373 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009374 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9375 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009376
9377 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9378 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009379 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009380 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9381 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9382 forwarded to this server.
9383
9384 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9385 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9386 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009387 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009388 a single "listen" section.
9389
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009390 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9391 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9392 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9393
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009394 Example :
9395 listen tse-farm
9396 bind :3389
9397 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9398 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9399 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9400 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9401 persist rdp-cookie
9402 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009403 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009404 balance rdp-cookie
9405 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9406 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9407
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009408 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9409 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009410
9411
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009412rate-limit sessions <rate>
9413 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9415 yes | yes | yes | no
9416 Arguments :
9417 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9418 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9419
9420 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9421 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9422 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9423 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9424 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9425 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9426
9427 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9428 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9429 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9430 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9431
9432 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9433 listen smtp
9434 mode tcp
9435 bind :25
9436 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009437 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009438
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009439 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9440 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9441 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009442
9443 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9444
9445
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009446redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9447redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9448redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009449 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9451 no | yes | yes | yes
9452
9453 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009454 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009455
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009456 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009457 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009458 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9459 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9460 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009461
9462 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9463 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9464 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9465 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9466 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009467 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9468 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9469 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9470 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009471
9472 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9473 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9474 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9475 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9476 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9477 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009478 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009479 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009480 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9481 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9482 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009483
9484 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009485 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9486 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9487 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009488 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009489 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9490 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9491 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9492 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009493
9494 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009495 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009496
9497 - "drop-query"
9498 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9499 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9500 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9501 with a location-type redirect.
9502
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009503 - "append-slash"
9504 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9505 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9506 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9507 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9508
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009509 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9510 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9511 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9512 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9513 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9514 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9515 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9516
9517 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9518 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9519 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9520 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9521 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9522 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9523 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009524
9525 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9526 acl clear dst_port 80
9527 acl secure dst_port 8080
9528 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009529 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009530 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009531 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9532
9533 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009534 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9535 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9536 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009537 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009538
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009539 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9540 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9541 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9542
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009543 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009544 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009545
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009546 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009547 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9548 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9549 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009550
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009551 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009552
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009553
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009554retries <value>
9555 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9556 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9557 yes | no | yes | yes
9558 Arguments :
9559 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9560 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9561 default value is 3.
9562
9563 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9564 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9565 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9566
9567 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009568 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9569 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009570
9571 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9572 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9573
9574 See also : "option redispatch"
9575
9576
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009577retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009578 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9579 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9580 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009581 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9582 yes | no | yes | yes
9583 Arguments :
9584 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9585 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9586 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9587 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9588
9589 none never retry
9590
9591 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9592 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9593
9594 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9595 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9596 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9597 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9598 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9599 processing the request.
9600
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009601 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9602 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9603 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9604 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9605 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9606 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9607 overflow attack for example).
9608
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009609 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9610 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9611 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9612 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9613 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9614 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9615 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9616 amplify denial of service attacks.
9617
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009618 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9619 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9620 considered to be safe to retry.
9621
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +01009622 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
9623 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
9624 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
9625 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
9626 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009627
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009628 all-retryable-errors
9629 retry request for any error that are considered
9630 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9631 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9632 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9633
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009634 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9635 not cumulative.
9636
9637 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9638 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9639 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9640 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9641
9642 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9643 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9644 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9645 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9646 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9647 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9648 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9649 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9650 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9651 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9652 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9653 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9654
9655 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9656 should not use this directive.
9657
9658 The default is "conn-failure".
9659
9660 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9661
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009662server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009663 Declare a server in a backend
9664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9665 no | no | yes | yes
9666 Arguments :
9667 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009668 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009669 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009670
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009671 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9672 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9673 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9674 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009675 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9676 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9677 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9678 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9679 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009680 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9681 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9682 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9683 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9684 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9685 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9686 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009687 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009688 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9689 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9690 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9691 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9692 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9693 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009694 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9695 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009696 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9697 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009698
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009699 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009700 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9701 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9702 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9703 adding this value to the client's port.
9704
9705 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9706 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009707 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009708
9709 Examples :
9710 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9711 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009712 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009713 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9714 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9715 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009716
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009717 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9718 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9719 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9720 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9721 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9722
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009723 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9724 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009725
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009726server-state-file-name [<file>]
9727 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
9728 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
9729 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
9730 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
9731 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
9732 global directive "server-state-file-base".
9733
9734 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9735 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9736
9737 global
9738 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9739
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009740 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009741 load-server-state-from-file
9742
9743 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
9744 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009745
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009746server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9747 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9748 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9750 no | no | yes | yes
9751
9752 Arguments:
9753 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9754
9755 <num | range>
9756 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9757 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9758 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9759 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9760
9761 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9762
9763 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9764
9765 <params*>
9766 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9767 keyword.
9768
9769 Examples:
9770 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9771 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9772 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9773
9774 # or
9775 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9776
9777 # would be equivalent to:
9778 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9779 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9780 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9781
9782
9783
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009784source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009785source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009786source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009787 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9789 yes | no | yes | yes
9790 Arguments :
9791 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9792 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009793
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009794 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009795 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9796 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9797 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9798 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9799 supported prefixes are :
9800 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9801 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9802 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009803 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009804 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9805 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009806
9807 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9808 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009809 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9810 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9811 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009812
9813 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9814 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9815 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9816 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9817 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9818 <addr>.
9819
9820 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9821 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9822 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9823 port.
9824
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009825 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9826 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9827 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9828 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009829 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009830 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9831 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9832 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9833 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9834 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9835 HTTP header.
9836
9837 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9838 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009839 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009840 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9841 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9842 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9843 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9844 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9845 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9846 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9847
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009848 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9849 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9850 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9851 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9852 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9853 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9854
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009855 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9856 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9857 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9858 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9859
9860 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9861 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9862 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9863 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9864 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9865 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9866
9867 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9868 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9869 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9870 there are two methods :
9871
9872 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9873 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9874 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9875 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9876 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9877 of the client ranges may be used.
9878
9879 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9880 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9881 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9882 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9883 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9884 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9885 same session.
9886
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009887 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9888 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9889 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009890 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009891
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009892 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9893
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009894 Examples :
9895 backend private
9896 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9897 source 192.168.1.200
9898
9899 backend transparent_ssl1
9900 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9901 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9902
9903 backend transparent_ssl2
9904 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9905 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9906 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9907
9908 backend transparent_ssl3
9909 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9910 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9911 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9912
9913 backend transparent_smtp
9914 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9915 # with Tproxy version 4.
9916 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9917
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009918 backend transparent_http
9919 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9920 # proxy.
9921 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9922
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009923 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009924 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9925
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009926
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009927srvtcpka-cnt <count>
9928 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
9929 the connection on the server side.
9930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9931 yes | no | yes | yes
9932 Arguments :
9933 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
9934
9935 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
9936 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009937 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9938 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009939
9940 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9941
9942
9943srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
9944 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
9945 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
9946 server side.
9947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9948 yes | no | yes | yes
9949 Arguments :
9950 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
9951 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
9952 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
9953 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
9954
9955 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
9956 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009957 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9958 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009959
9960 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9961
9962
9963srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
9964 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
9965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9966 yes | no | yes | yes
9967 Arguments :
9968 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
9969 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
9970 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
9971 document.
9972
9973 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
9974 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009975 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9976 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009977
9978 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
9979
9980
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009981stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9982 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009984 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009985
9986 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9987 matched.
9988
9989 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9990 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9991
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009992 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9993 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009994 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009995
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009996 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9997 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9998 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9999 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010000
10001 Example :
10002 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10003 backend stats_localhost
10004 stats enable
10005 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10006
10007 Example :
10008 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10009 backend stats_auth
10010 stats enable
10011 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10012 stats admin if TRUE
10013
10014 Example :
10015 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10016 userlist stats-auth
10017 group admin users admin
10018 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10019 group readonly users haproxy
10020 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10021
10022 backend stats_auth
10023 stats enable
10024 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10025 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10026 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10027 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10028
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010029 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10030 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10031 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010032
10033
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010034stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10035 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010037 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010038 Arguments :
10039 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10040
10041 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10042
10043 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10044 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10045 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10046 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10047 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10048 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10049
10050 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10051 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10052 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010053 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010054
10055 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10056 report using "stats scope".
10057
10058 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10059 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10060 unobvious parameters.
10061
10062 Example :
10063 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10064 backend public_www
10065 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10066 stats enable
10067 stats hide-version
10068 stats scope .
10069 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010070 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010071 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10072 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10073
10074 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10075 backend private_monitoring
10076 stats enable
10077 stats uri /admin?stats
10078 stats refresh 5s
10079
10080 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10081
10082
10083stats enable
10084 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010086 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010087 Arguments : none
10088
10089 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10090 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10091 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10092 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10093 - stats auth : no authentication
10094 - stats scope : no restriction
10095
10096 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10097 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10098 unobvious parameters.
10099
10100 Example :
10101 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10102 backend public_www
10103 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10104 stats enable
10105 stats hide-version
10106 stats scope .
10107 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010108 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010109 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10110 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10111
10112 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10113 backend private_monitoring
10114 stats enable
10115 stats uri /admin?stats
10116 stats refresh 5s
10117
10118 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10119
10120
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010121stats hide-version
10122 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010124 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010125 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010126
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010127 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10128 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10129 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10130 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10131 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10132 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010133
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010134 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10135 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10136 unobvious parameters.
10137
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010138 Example :
10139 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10140 backend public_www
10141 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010142 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010143 stats hide-version
10144 stats scope .
10145 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010146 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010147 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10148 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010149
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010150 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10151 backend private_monitoring
10152 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010153 stats uri /admin?stats
10154 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010155
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010156 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010157
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010158
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010159stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10160 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10161 Access control for statistics
10162
10163 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10164 no | no | yes | yes
10165
10166 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10167 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10168 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10169 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10170 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10171 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10172
10173 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10174 instance.
10175
10176 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10177 about ACL usage.
10178
10179
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010180stats realm <realm>
10181 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010183 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010184 Arguments :
10185 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10186 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10187 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10188
10189 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10190 using a backslash ('\').
10191
10192 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10193 only related to authentication.
10194
10195 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10196 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10197 unobvious parameters.
10198
10199 Example :
10200 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10201 backend public_www
10202 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10203 stats enable
10204 stats hide-version
10205 stats scope .
10206 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010207 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010208 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10209 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10210
10211 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10212 backend private_monitoring
10213 stats enable
10214 stats uri /admin?stats
10215 stats refresh 5s
10216
10217 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10218
10219
10220stats refresh <delay>
10221 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010223 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010224 Arguments :
10225 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10226 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10227 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10228 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10229 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10230 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10231
10232 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10233 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10234 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010235 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010236
10237 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10238 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10239 unobvious parameters.
10240
10241 Example :
10242 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10243 backend public_www
10244 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10245 stats enable
10246 stats hide-version
10247 stats scope .
10248 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010249 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010250 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10251 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10252
10253 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10254 backend private_monitoring
10255 stats enable
10256 stats uri /admin?stats
10257 stats refresh 5s
10258
10259 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10260
10261
10262stats scope { <name> | "." }
10263 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010265 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010266 Arguments :
10267 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10268 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10269 section in which the statement appears.
10270
10271 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10272 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10273 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10274 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10275 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10276 exists.
10277
10278 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10279 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10280 unobvious parameters.
10281
10282 Example :
10283 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10284 backend public_www
10285 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10286 stats enable
10287 stats hide-version
10288 stats scope .
10289 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010290 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010291 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10292 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10293
10294 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10295 backend private_monitoring
10296 stats enable
10297 stats uri /admin?stats
10298 stats refresh 5s
10299
10300 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10301
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010302
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010303stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010304 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010306 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010307
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010308 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010309 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10310
10311 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10312 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10313
10314 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10315 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010316 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010317
10318 Example :
10319 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10320 backend private_monitoring
10321 stats enable
10322 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10323 stats uri /admin?stats
10324 stats refresh 5s
10325
10326 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10327 global section.
10328
10329
10330stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010331 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10333 yes | yes | yes | yes
10334 Arguments : none
10335
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010336 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010337 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10338 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10339 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10340 - IP (socket, server)
10341 - cookie (backend, server)
10342
10343 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10344 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010345 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010346
10347 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10348
10349
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010350stats show-modules
10351 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10353 yes | yes | yes | yes
10354 Arguments : none
10355
10356 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10357 values as a tooltip.
10358
10359 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10360 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10361 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10362
10363 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10364
10365
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010366stats show-node [ <name> ]
10367 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010369 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010370 Arguments:
10371 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10372 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10373
10374 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10375 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010376 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010377
10378 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10379 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10380 unobvious parameters.
10381
10382 Example:
10383 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10384 backend private_monitoring
10385 stats enable
10386 stats show-node Europe-1
10387 stats uri /admin?stats
10388 stats refresh 5s
10389
10390 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10391 section.
10392
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010393
10394stats uri <prefix>
10395 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010397 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010398 Arguments :
10399 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10400 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10401 query string.
10402
10403 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10404 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10405 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10406 possible to reach it in the application.
10407
10408 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010409 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010410 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10411 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10412 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10413 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10414
10415 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10416 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10417 an address or a port to statistics only.
10418
10419 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10420 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10421 unobvious parameters.
10422
10423 Example :
10424 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10425 backend public_www
10426 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10427 stats enable
10428 stats hide-version
10429 stats scope .
10430 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010431 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010432 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10433 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10434
10435 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10436 backend private_monitoring
10437 stats enable
10438 stats uri /admin?stats
10439 stats refresh 5s
10440
10441 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10442
10443
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010444stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10445 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010447 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010448
10449 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010450 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010451 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010452 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010453 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10454
10455 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10456 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10457 the "stick-table" statement.
10458
10459 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10460 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10461 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10462 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10463 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10464
10465 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10466 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10467 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10468 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10469 transformation rules.
10470
10471 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10472 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10473 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10474 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10475 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10476 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10477 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10478
10479 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10480 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10481 ACL based conditions.
10482
10483 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10484 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10485 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10486 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10487
10488 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10489 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10490 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10491 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10492
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010493 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10494 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010495 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010496
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010497 Example :
10498 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10499 # last 30 minutes
10500 backend pop
10501 mode tcp
10502 balance roundrobin
10503 stick store-request src
10504 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10505 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10506 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10507
10508 backend smtp
10509 mode tcp
10510 balance roundrobin
10511 stick match src table pop
10512 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10513 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10514
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010515 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010516 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010517
10518
10519stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10520 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10522 no | no | yes | yes
10523
10524 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10525 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10526 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10527 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10528
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010529 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10530 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010531 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010532
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010533 Examples :
10534 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010535 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010536
10537 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10538 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10539 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10540
10541
10542 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10543 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10544 backend http
10545 mode http
10546 balance roundrobin
10547 stick on src table https
10548 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10549 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10550 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10551
10552 backend https
10553 mode tcp
10554 balance roundrobin
10555 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10556 stick on src
10557 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10558 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10559
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010560 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010561
10562
10563stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10564 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10566 no | no | yes | yes
10567
10568 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010569 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010570 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010571 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010572 server is selected.
10573
10574 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10575 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10576 the "stick-table" statement.
10577
10578 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10579 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10580 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10581 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10582 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10583 address.
10584
10585 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10586 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10587 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10588 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10589 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10590 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10591 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10592 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10593 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10594 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10595
10596 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10597 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10598 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10599 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10600 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10601 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10602 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10603
10604 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10605 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10606 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10607 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10608
10609 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10610 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10611 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10612 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10613 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10614 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010615 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10616 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10617 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10618 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10619 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10620 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010621
10622 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10623 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10624 the request.
10625
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010626 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10627 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010628 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010629
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010630 Example :
10631 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10632 # last 30 minutes
10633 backend pop
10634 mode tcp
10635 balance roundrobin
10636 stick store-request src
10637 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10638 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10639 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10640
10641 backend smtp
10642 mode tcp
10643 balance roundrobin
10644 stick match src table pop
10645 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10646 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10647
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010648 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010649 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010650
10651
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010652stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070010653 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010654 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010655 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010657 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010658
10659 Arguments :
10660 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10661 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10662 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10663 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10664
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010665 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10666 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10667 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10668 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10669
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010670 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10671 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10672 instance.
10673
10674 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10675 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10676 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10677 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10678 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10679 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010680 to 32 characters.
10681
10682 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10683 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10684 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010685 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010686 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10687 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010688
10689 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010690 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10691 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010692 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10693 increase.
10694
10695 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010696 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10697 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10698 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010699
10700 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10701 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10702 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10703 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010704 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010705 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10706 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10707 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10708 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10709 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10710 parameter (see below).
10711
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010712 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10713 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10714 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10715 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10716 soft restart.
10717
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010718 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10719 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010720
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010721 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10722 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10723 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10724 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010725 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010726 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010727 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10728 if not expiration delay is specified.
10729
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070010730 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
10731 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
10732 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
10733 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
10734 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
10735 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
10736 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
10737 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
10738 token.
10739
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010740 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10741 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10742 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10743 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010744 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10745 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10746 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10747 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10748 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10749 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10750 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10751 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10752 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10753 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10754 types and their arguments.
10755
10756 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10757 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10758 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10759 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10760
10761 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10762 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10763 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010764 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010765
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010766 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10767 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10768 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010769 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010770 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010771 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010772
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010773 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10774 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10775 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10776 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10777
10778 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10779 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10780 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10781 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10782 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10783 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10784
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010785 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10786 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10787 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10788 they were received.
10789
10790 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10791 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10792 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10793 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10794 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10795
10796 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10797 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10798 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10799 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10800 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10801
10802 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10803 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10804 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10805
10806 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10807 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10808 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10809 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10810 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10811
10812 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10813 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10814 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10815 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10816 the client side.
10817
10818 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10819 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10820 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10821 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10822 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10823 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10824 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10825
10826 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10827 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10828 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10829 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10830 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10831 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010832 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010833
10834 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10835 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10836 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10837 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10838 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10839 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10840
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010010841 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10842 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
10843 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10844 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
10845 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
10846
10847 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10848 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10849 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10850 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10851 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
10852 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10853
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010854 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010855 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010856 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10857 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10858
10859 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10860 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10861 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10862 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10863 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10864 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10865 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10866 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10867 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10868 recommended for better fairness.
10869
10870 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010871 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010872 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10873 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10874
10875 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10876 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10877 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10878 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10879 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10880 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10881 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10882 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10883 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10884 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010885
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010886 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10887 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010888 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10889 reference it.
10890
10891 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10892 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010893 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10894 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10895 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010896
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010897 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10898 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10899 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10900 something that can be ignored.
10901
10902 Example:
10903 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10904 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10905 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10906 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10907
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010908 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010909 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010910
10911
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010912stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010913 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10915 no | no | yes | yes
10916
10917 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010918 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010919 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010920 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010921 server is selected.
10922
10923 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10924 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10925 the "stick-table" statement.
10926
10927 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10928 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10929 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10930 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10931
10932 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10933 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10934 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10935 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10936 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10937 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010938 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010939 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10940 rules.
10941
10942 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10943 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10944 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10945 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10946 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10947 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10948 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10949
10950 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10951 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10952 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10953 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10954
10955 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10956 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10957 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10958 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10959 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10960 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010961 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10962 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10963 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10964 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10965 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10966 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10967 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10968 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10969 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010970
10971 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10972
10973 Example :
10974 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10975 backend https
10976 mode tcp
10977 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010978 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010979 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010980
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010981 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10982 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10983
10984 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10985 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10986 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10987
10988 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10989 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010990
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010991 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10992 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10993 # at offset 44.
10994
10995 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10996 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10997
10998 # Learn on response if server hello.
10999 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011000
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011001 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11002 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11003
11004 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11005 extraction.
11006
11007
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011008tcp-check comment <string>
11009 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11010 it fails.
11011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11012 yes | no | yes | yes
11013
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011014 Arguments :
11015 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11016 rule fails.
11017
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011018 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11019 user-friendly error reporting.
11020
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011021 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11022 "tcp-check expect".
11023
11024
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011025tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11026 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011027 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011028 Opens a new connection
11029 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011030 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011031
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011032 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011033 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11034
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011035 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011036 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011037
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011038 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011039 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11040 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011041 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011042
11043 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011044
11045 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11046
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011047 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11048
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011049 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11050
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011051 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11052
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011053 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11054 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11055 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11056 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11057
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011058 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11059 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11060 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11061 haproxy -vv.
11062
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011063 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011064
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011065 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11066 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11067 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11068
11069 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11070 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11071 of the sequence.
11072
11073 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11074 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11075 do.
11076
11077 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11078 unset-var or comment rules.
11079
11080 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011081 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11082 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11083 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11084 option tcp-check
11085 tcp-check connect
11086 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11087 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11088 tcp-check send \r\n
11089 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11090 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11091 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11092 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11093 tcp-check send \r\n
11094 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11095 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11096
11097 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11098 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011099 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011100 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11101 tcp-check connect port 143
11102 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11103 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11104
11105 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11106
11107
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011108tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011109 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011110 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011111 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011112 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011113 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011114 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011115
11116 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011117 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11118
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011119 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11120 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11121 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11122 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11123 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11124 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11125 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11126 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11127 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11128 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11129
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011130 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011131 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11132 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011133 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11134 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11135 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11136
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011137 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11138 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11139 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011140 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11141 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011142 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11143 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011144 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11145 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011146 By default "L7OK" is used.
11147
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011148 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11149 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011150 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11151 supported :
11152 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11153 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011154 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11155 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11156 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11157 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11158 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011159
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011160 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011161 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011162 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11163 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11164 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11165 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011166 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11167
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011168 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11169 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11170 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11171 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11172
11173 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11174 informational message reported in logs if an error
11175 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11176 log-format string.
11177
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011178 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11179 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11180 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11181 followed by some converters.
11182
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011183 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11184 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11185 with the usual backslash ('\').
11186 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011187 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011188 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11189 used upper or lower case.
11190
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011191 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11192
11193 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11194 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11195 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11196 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11197 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11198 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11199 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11200 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11201
11202 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11203 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11204 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11205 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11206 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11207 expression.
11208
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011209 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11210 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11211 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11212 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11213 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11214 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11215
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011216 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11217 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11218 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11219 this exact hexadecimal string.
11220 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11221
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011222 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11223 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11224 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11225 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11226 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11227 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11228 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11229 size.
11230
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011231 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11232 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11233 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11234 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11235 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11236 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11237 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11238 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11239 in a binary string before matching the response's
11240 buffer.
11241
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011242 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011243 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011244 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11245 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11246 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11247 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11248 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11249 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11250 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11251 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11252 the null character.
11253
11254 Examples :
11255 # perform a POP check
11256 option tcp-check
11257 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11258
11259 # perform an IMAP check
11260 option tcp-check
11261 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11262
11263 # look for the redis master server
11264 option tcp-check
11265 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011266 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011267 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11268 tcp-check expect string role:master
11269 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11270 tcp-check expect string +OK
11271
11272
11273 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011274 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011275
11276
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011277tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11278tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11279 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11280 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011281 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011282 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011283
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011284 Arguments :
11285 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11286
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011287 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11288 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011289
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011290 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11291 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011292
11293 Examples :
11294 # look for the redis master server
11295 option tcp-check
11296 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11297 tcp-check expect string role:master
11298
11299 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011300 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011301
11302
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011303tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11304tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11305 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11306 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011307 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011308 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011309
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011310 Arguments :
11311 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011312
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011313 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11314 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011315
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011316 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11317 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11318 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011319
11320 Examples :
11321 # redis check in binary
11322 option tcp-check
11323 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11324 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11325
11326
11327 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011328 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011329
11330
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011331tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011332 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011333 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011334 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011335
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011336 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011337 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11338 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11339 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11340 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11341 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11342 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11343 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11344 and '-'.
11345
11346 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11347
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011348 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011349 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11350
11351
11352tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011353 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011354 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011355 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011356
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011357 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011358 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11359 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11360 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11361 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11362 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11363 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11364 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11365 and '-'.
11366
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011367 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011368 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11369
11370
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011371tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11372 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11374 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011375 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011376 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11377 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011378
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011379 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011380
11381 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11382 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011383 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11384 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11385 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11386 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11387 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11388 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011389
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011390 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11391 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11392 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11393 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011394
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011395 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011396 - accept :
11397 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11398 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11399 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011400
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011401 - reject :
11402 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11403 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11404 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11405 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11406 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11407 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11408 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11409 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11410 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11411 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11412 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011413 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011414
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011415 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11416 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11417 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11418 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11419 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11420 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11421 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11422 hosts.
11423
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011424 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11425 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11426 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11427 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11428 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11429 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11430 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11431 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11432
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011433 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11434 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11435 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11436 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11437 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11438 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11439 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11440 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11441 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011442 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11443 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011444
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011445 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011446 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011447 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11448 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11449 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011450 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011451 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011452 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11453 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11454 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11455 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11456 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11457 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11458 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011459
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011460 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011461 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011462 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011463 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011464 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11465 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11466 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011467
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011468 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11469 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11470 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11471 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011472
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011473 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11474 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11475 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11476 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11477 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011478 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11479 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11480 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11481 layer7 information is extracted.
11482
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011483 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11484 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11485 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11486 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11487 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011488
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011489 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11490 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11491 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11492 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11493
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011494 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11495 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11496 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11497 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11498
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011499 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11500 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11501 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11502 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11503 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011504
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011505 - set-src <expr> :
11506 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11507 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11508 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011509 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011510
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011511 Arguments:
11512 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11513 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011514
11515 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011516 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11517
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011518 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11519 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011520
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011521 - set-src-port <expr> :
11522 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11523 expression.
11524
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011525 Arguments:
11526 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11527 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011528
11529 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011530 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11531
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011532 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11533 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11534 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011535
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011536 - set-dst <expr> :
11537 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11538 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11539 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11540 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11541 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11542
11543 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11544 followed by some converters.
11545
11546 Example:
11547
11548 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11549 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11550
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011551 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11552 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11553
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011554 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11555 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11556 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11557 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11558
11559
11560 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11561 followed by some converters.
11562
11563 Example:
11564
11565 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11566
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011567 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11568 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11569 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11570
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011571 - "silent-drop" :
11572 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011573 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011574 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11575 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11576 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11577 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11578 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011579 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11580 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011581 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11582 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011583 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011584 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11585 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11586 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11587 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11588
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011589 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11590 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11591 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011592
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011593 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11594 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11595 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011596
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011597 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011598 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011599 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011600
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011601 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11602 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11603 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011604
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011605 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011606 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11607 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011608
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011609 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11610
11611 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11612
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011613 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11614
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011615 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011616
11617
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011618tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11619 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011621 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011622 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011623 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11624 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011625
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011626 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011627
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011628 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011629 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11630 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
11631 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
11632 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011633
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011634 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11635 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11636 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11637 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011638 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11639 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11640 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11641 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11642 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11643 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011644 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011645 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011646
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011647 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11648 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11649 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11650 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011651
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011652 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011653 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011654 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011655 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11656 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011657 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011658 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011659 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011660 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011661 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011662 - set-dst <expr>
11663 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011664 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011665 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011666 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011667 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011668 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011669
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011670 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11671 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011672 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11673 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011674
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011675 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11676 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11677 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11678 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11679 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11680 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011681
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011682 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011683 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11684 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011685
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020011686 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
11687 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
11688 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
11689 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
11690 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
11691 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
11692
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011693 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020011694 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
11695 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
11696 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
11697 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
11698 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
11699 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
11700 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
11701 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
11702 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
11703 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011704
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011705 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011706 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11707 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11708 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011709
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011710 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11711 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11712
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011713 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011714 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11715 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011716
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011717 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11718 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011719 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011720 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11721 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011722 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011723 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011724 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011725 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11726 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011727 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011728 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11729 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011730
11731 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11732 followed by some converters.
11733
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011734 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11735 <var-name>.
11736
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011737 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11738 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11739 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11740 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11741 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11742
11743 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11744 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11745 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11746 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11747 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11748 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11749 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11750 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11751 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11752 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11753 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11754
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011755 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11756 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11757 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11758 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11759 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11760
11761 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11762
11763 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11764
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011765 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11766 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11767 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11768 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11769 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11770 evaluated.
11771
11772 Example:
11773 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11774
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011775 Example:
11776
11777 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011778 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011779
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011780 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011781 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11782 # and reject everything else.
11783 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11784 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011785 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011786 tcp-request content reject
11787
11788 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011789 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11790 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11791 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011792 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011793
11794 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11795 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11796 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011797 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011798 tcp-request content reject
11799
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011800 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011801 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011802 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011803 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011804 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11805 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011806
11807 Example:
11808 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11809 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011810 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011811
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011812 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011813 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011814
11815 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011816 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011817 # protecting all our sites
11818 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011819 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11820 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011821 ...
11822 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11823
11824 backend http_dynamic
11825 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011826 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011827 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011828 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011829 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011830 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011831 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011832
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011833 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011834
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011835 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11836 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011837
11838
11839tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11840 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11841 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011842 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011843 Arguments :
11844 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11845 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11846 as explained at the top of this document.
11847
11848 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11849 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11850 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11851 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11852 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11853
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011854 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11855 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11856 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11857 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11858
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011859 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11860 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011861 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011862 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011863 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11864 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11865 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11866 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011867
11868 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11869 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11870 it pass through unaffected.
11871
11872 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11873 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11874 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011875 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011876 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11877 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011878 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11879 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11880 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011881
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011882 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011883 "timeout client".
11884
11885
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011886tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11887 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11889 no | no | yes | yes
11890 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011891 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11892 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011893
11894 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11895
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011896 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011897 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11898 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011899 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11900 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011901
11902 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11903
11904 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11905 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11906 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11907 inserted.
11908
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011909 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011910 - accept :
11911 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11912 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11913 the rules evaluation.
11914
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011915 - close :
11916 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11917 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11918 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11919 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11920 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11921 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011922 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011923 protocols.
11924
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011925 - reject :
11926 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11927 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011928 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011929
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011930 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11931 Sets a variable.
11932
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011933 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11934 Unsets a variable.
11935
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011936 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11937 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11938 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11939 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11940
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011941 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11942 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11943 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11944 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11945
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011946 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11947 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11948 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11949 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11950 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011951
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011952 - "silent-drop" :
11953 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011954 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011955 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11956 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11957 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11958 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11959 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011960 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11961 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011962 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11963 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011964 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011965 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11966 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11967 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11968 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11969
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011970 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11971 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11972
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011973 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11974 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11975 for changing the default action to a reject.
11976
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011977 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11978 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11979 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11980 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011981 period.
11982
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011983 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11984 declared inline.
11985
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011986 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11987 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011988 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011989 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11990 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011991 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011992 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011993 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011994 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11995 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011996 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011997 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11998 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011999
12000 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12001 followed by some converters.
12002
12003 Example:
12004
12005 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
12006
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012007 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12008 <var-name>.
12009
12010 Example:
12011
12012 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
12013
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012014 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12015 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12016 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12017 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12018 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12019
12020 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12021
12022 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12023
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012024 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12025
12026 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12027
12028
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012029tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12030 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12032 no | yes | yes | no
12033 Arguments :
12034 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12035 below.
12036
12037 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12038
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012039 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012040 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12041 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12042 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12043 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12044 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12045 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12046 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012047 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012048 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12049 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12050 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12051 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12052 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12053 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12054 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12055 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12056 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12057 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12058 instead.
12059
12060 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12061 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12062 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12063 rules which may be inserted.
12064
12065 Several types of actions are supported :
12066 - accept : the request is accepted
12067 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12068 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12069 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012070 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012071 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012072 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012073 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012074 - silent-drop
12075
12076 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12077 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12078 sections for a complete description.
12079
12080 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12081 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12082 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12083
12084 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12085 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12086 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12087 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12088 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12089
12090 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12091 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12092
12093 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12094 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12095 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12096
12097 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12098 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12099 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12100
12101 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12102 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12103 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12104
12105 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12106 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12107 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12108
12109 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12110
12111 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12112
12113
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012114tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12115 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12117 no | no | yes | yes
12118 Arguments :
12119 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12120 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12121 as explained at the top of this document.
12122
12123 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12124
12125
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012126timeout check <timeout>
12127 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12128 established.
12129
12130 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12131 yes | no | yes | yes
12132 Arguments:
12133 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12134 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12135 as explained at the top of this document.
12136
12137 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
12138 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012139 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012140 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012141 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12142 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12143 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012144
12145 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
12146 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12147
12148 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12149 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012150 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012151
12152 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12153 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12154 forget about it.
12155
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012156 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12157 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012158
12159
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012160timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012161 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12163 yes | yes | yes | no
12164 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012165 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012166 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12167 as explained at the top of this document.
12168
12169 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12170 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12171 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012172 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12173 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12174 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12175 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012176 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12177 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12178 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012179 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012180 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012181 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12182 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012183 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12184 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012185
12186 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12187 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12188 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12189 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012190 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012191 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12192
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012193 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012194
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012195 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012196
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012197
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012198timeout client-fin <timeout>
12199 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12201 yes | yes | yes | no
12202 Arguments :
12203 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12204 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12205 as explained at the top of this document.
12206
12207 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12208 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12209 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12210 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12211 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12212 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12213 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012214 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12215 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12216 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012217
12218 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12219 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12220 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12221
12222 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12223
12224
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012225timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012226 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12228 yes | no | yes | yes
12229 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012230 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012231 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12232 as explained at the top of this document.
12233
12234 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012235 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012236 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012237 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012238 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12239 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012240
12241 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12242 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12243 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12244 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012245 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012246 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12247
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012248 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012249
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012250
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012251timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12252 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12254 yes | yes | yes | yes
12255 Arguments :
12256 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12257 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12258 as explained at the top of this document.
12259
12260 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12261 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12262 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12263 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12264 once the request has started to present itself.
12265
12266 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12267 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12268 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12269 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12270 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12271
12272 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12273 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12274 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12275 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12276
12277 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12278 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012279 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012280 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12281 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012282 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012283
12284 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12285 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12286 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12287 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12288
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012289 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12290 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012291 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12292
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012293 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12294
12295
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012296timeout http-request <timeout>
12297 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012299 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012300 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012301 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012302 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12303 as explained at the top of this document.
12304
12305 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12306 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12307 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12308 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12309 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12310 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12311 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012312 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12313 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12314 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12315 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012316 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012317 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12318 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012319
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012320 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12321 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12322 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12323 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12324 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012325 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012326
12327 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12328 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012329 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012330 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12331 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12332
12333 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012334 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12335 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12336 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012337
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012338 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012339 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012340
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012341
12342timeout queue <timeout>
12343 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12345 yes | no | yes | yes
12346 Arguments :
12347 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12348 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12349 as explained at the top of this document.
12350
12351 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12352 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12353 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12354 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12355 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12356
12357 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12358 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12359 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12360 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12361
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012362 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012363
12364
12365timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012366 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12368 yes | no | yes | yes
12369 Arguments :
12370 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12371 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12372 as explained at the top of this document.
12373
12374 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12375 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12376 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12377 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12378 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12379 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12380 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12381
12382 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12383 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12384 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12385 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12386 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012387 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012388 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012389 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12390 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012391 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12392 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012393
12394 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12395 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12396 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12397 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012398 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012399 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12400
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012401 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012402
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012403
12404timeout server-fin <timeout>
12405 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12407 yes | no | yes | yes
12408 Arguments :
12409 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12410 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12411 as explained at the top of this document.
12412
12413 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12414 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12415 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12416 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12417 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12418 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12419 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12420 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12421 situations, it should not be needed.
12422
12423 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12424 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12425 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12426
12427 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12428
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012429
12430timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012431 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12433 yes | yes | yes | yes
12434 Arguments :
12435 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12436 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12437 as explained at the top of this document.
12438
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012439 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12440 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12441 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012442
12443 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12444 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12445 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12446 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012447 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012448
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012449 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012450
12451
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012452timeout tunnel <timeout>
12453 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12455 yes | no | yes | yes
12456 Arguments :
12457 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12458 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12459 as explained at the top of this document.
12460
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012461 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012462 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12463 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12464 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012465 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12466 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012467 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12468 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12469 specified.
12470
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012471 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12472 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12473 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12474 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12475 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12476 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12477 state.
12478
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012479 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12480 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12481 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12482 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012483 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012484
12485 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12486 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12487 forget about it.
12488
12489 Example :
12490 defaults http
12491 option http-server-close
12492 timeout connect 5s
12493 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012494 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012495 timeout server 30s
12496 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12497
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012498 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012499
12500
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012501transparent (deprecated)
12502 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012504 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012505 Arguments : none
12506
12507 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12508 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12509 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12510 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12511 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12512 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12513 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12514 appropriate server.
12515
12516 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12517
12518 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12519 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12520
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012521 See also: "option transparent"
12522
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012523unique-id-format <string>
12524 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12526 yes | yes | yes | no
12527 Arguments :
12528 <string> is a log-format string.
12529
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012530 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12531 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12532 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12533 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012534
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012535 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12536 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12537 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12538 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12539 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12540 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12541 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12542 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012543
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012544 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12545 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012546
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012547 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012548
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012549 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012550
12551 will generate:
12552
12553 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12554
12555 See also: "unique-id-header"
12556
12557unique-id-header <name>
12558 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12560 yes | yes | yes | no
12561 Arguments :
12562 <name> is the name of the header.
12563
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012564 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12565 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012566
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012567 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012568
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012569 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012570 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12571
12572 will generate:
12573
12574 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12575
12576 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012577
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012578use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012579 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12581 no | yes | yes | no
12582 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012583 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12584 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012585
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012586 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12587 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012588
12589 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12590 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12591 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012592 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012593 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012594 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12595 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012596
12597 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12598 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12599 assign the backend.
12600
12601 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12602 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12603 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12604 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12605 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12606 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12607
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012608 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012609 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012610 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12611 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12612 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12613
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012614 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12615 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
12616 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
12617 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
12618 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
12619 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
12620 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
12621 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12622 cannot be forced from the request.
12623
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012624 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012625 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12626 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12627
12628 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12629 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012630
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012631use-fcgi-app <name>
12632 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12634 no | no | yes | yes
12635 Arguments :
12636 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12637
12638 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012639
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012640use-server <server> if <condition>
12641use-server <server> unless <condition>
12642 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12644 no | no | yes | yes
12645 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012646 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12647 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012648
12649 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12650
12651 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12652 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12653 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12654
12655 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12656 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12657 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12658 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12659 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12660 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12661 matches will assign the server.
12662
12663 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12664 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12665 with the next rules until one matches.
12666
12667 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12668 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12669 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12670 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12671
12672 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12673 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12674 stripped.
12675
12676 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12677 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012678 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
12679 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
12680 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012681
12682 Example :
12683 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12684 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12685 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12686 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012687 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012688 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012689 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012690 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12691 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12692
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012693 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12694 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12695 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12696 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012697 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012698 and we fall back to load balancing.
12699
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012700 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012701
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012702
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100127035. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012704--------------------------
12705
12706The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12707depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12708settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12709written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12710described in this section.
12711
12712
127135.1. Bind options
12714-----------------
12715
12716The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12717as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12718no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12719parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12720while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12721provided immediately after the setting name.
12722
12723The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12724
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012725accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12726 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12727 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12728 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12729 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12730 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12731 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12732 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12733 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12734 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012735 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12736 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12737 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012738
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012739accept-proxy
12740 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012741 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12742 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012743 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12744 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12745 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12746 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012747 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012748 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12749 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012750 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12751 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012752
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012753allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012754 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012755 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012756 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012757 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12758 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012759
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012760alpn <protocols>
12761 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12762 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12763 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012764 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012765 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012766 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12767 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12768 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12769 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12770 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12771 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12772 preference, like below :
12773
12774 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012775
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012776backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012777 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012778 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12779
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012780curves <curves>
12781 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12782 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12783 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12784 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12785 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12786 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12787
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012788ecdhe <named curve>
12789 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012790 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12791 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012792
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012793ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012794 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12795 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12796 client's certificate.
12797
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012798ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12799 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12800 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12801 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12802 error is ignored.
12803
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012804ca-sign-file <cafile>
12805 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12806 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12807 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12808 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12809 'generate-certificates' for details.
12810
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012811ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012812 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12813 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12814 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12815 'generate-certificates' for details.
12816
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012817ca-verify-file <cafile>
12818 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12819 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12820 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12821 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12822 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12823
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012824ciphers <ciphers>
12825 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12826 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012827 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012828 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012829 information and recommendations see e.g.
12830 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12831 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12832 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12833
12834ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12835 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12836 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12837 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12838 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012839 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12840 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012841
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012842crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012843 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12844 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12845 to verify client's certificate.
12846
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012847crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012848 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12849 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12850 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12851 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12852 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012853 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12854 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012855
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012856 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12857 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12858
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012859 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12860 are loaded.
12861
12862 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012863 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12864 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12865 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12866 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12867 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12868 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12869 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012870 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012871
12872 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12873 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12874 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12875 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012876 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12877 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012878
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012879 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012880
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012881 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012882 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012883 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12884 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012885 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12886 clients).
12887
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012888 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12889 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12890 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12891 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12892 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12893 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12894 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12895 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12896 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12897 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12898 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12899 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12900 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12901
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012902 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12903 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12904 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12905 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12906 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12907
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012908 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12909 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12910 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12911 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012912
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012913 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
12914 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
12915 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012916
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012917crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012918 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012919 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012920 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012921 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012922
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012923crt-list <file>
12924 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012925 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12926 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012927
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012928 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12929
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020012930 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12931 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
12932 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
12933 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
12934 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012935
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012936 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012937 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
12938 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
12939 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
12940 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
12941 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012942 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12943 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12944 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012945
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012946 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
12947 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
12948 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012949
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012950 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
12951
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030012952 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
12953 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which haproxy should use in
12954 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
12955 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
12956 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
12957 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
12958 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
12959 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012960
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012961 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012962 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012963 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012964 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012965 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012966 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012967
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012968defer-accept
12969 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12970 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12971 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012972 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012973 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12974 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12975 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12976 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12977 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12978 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12979 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12980
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012981expose-fd listeners
12982 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12983 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012984 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12985 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012986 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012987
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012988force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012989 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012990 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012991 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012992 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012993
12994force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012995 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012996 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012997 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012998
12999force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013000 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013001 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013002 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013003
13004force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013005 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013006 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013007 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013008
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013009force-tlsv13
13010 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13011 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013012 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013013
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013014generate-certificates
13015 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13016 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13017 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13018 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13019 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13020 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13021 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13022 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13023 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13024 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13025 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13026
13027 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13028 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013029 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013030 certificate is used many times.
13031
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013032gid <gid>
13033 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13034 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13035 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13036 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13037 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13038
13039group <group>
13040 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13041 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13042 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13043 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13044 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13045
13046id <id>
13047 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13048 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13049 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13050 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13051
13052interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013053 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13054 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13055 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13056 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13057 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13058 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013059 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13060 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13061 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13062 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13063 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13064 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013065
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013066level <level>
13067 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13068 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13069 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013070 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013071 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13072 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13073 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013074 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013075 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013076 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013077 all counters).
13078
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013079severity-output <format>
13080 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13081 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13082 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13083 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13084 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13085 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13086 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13087 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13088 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13089 rfc5424 convention.
13090
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013091maxconn <maxconn>
13092 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13093 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13094 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13095 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13096 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13097 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13098 eat all memory.
13099
13100mode <mode>
13101 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13102 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13103 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13104 UNIX sockets.
13105
13106mss <maxseg>
13107 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13108 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13109 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13110 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13111 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13112 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13113 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13114 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13115 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13116 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13117 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13118
13119name <name>
13120 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13121 page.
13122
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013123namespace <name>
13124 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13125 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13126 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13127 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13128
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013129nice <nice>
13130 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13131 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13132 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13133 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13134 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13135 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13136 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13137 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13138 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13139 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13140 one for an RDP socket.
13141
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013142no-ca-names
13143 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13144 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013145 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013146
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013147no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013148 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013149 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013150 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013151 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013152 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13153 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013154
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013155no-tls-tickets
13156 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13157 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13158 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013159 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13160 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013161 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13162 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13163 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013164
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013165no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013166 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013167 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013168 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013169 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013170 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13171 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013172
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013173no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013174 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013175 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013176 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013177 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013178 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13179 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013180
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013181no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013182 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013183 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013184 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013185 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013186 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13187 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013188
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013189no-tlsv13
13190 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13191 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13192 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13193 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013194 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13195 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013196
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013197npn <protocols>
13198 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13199 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13200 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013201 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013202 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013203 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13204 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13205 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13206 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13207 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013208
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013209prefer-client-ciphers
13210 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13211 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13212 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013213 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13214 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13215 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013216
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013217process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013218 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013219 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013220 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013221 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13222 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13223 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13224 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013225 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013226 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13227 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13228 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13229 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13230 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013231
13232 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13233
13234 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13235 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13236 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13237 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13238 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13239 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13240 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13241 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013242
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013243proto <name>
13244 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13245 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13246 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
13247 in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013248 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013249 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013250 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013251 h2" on the bind line.
13252
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013253ssl
13254 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013255 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013256 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13257 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013258 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13259 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013260
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013261ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13262 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013263 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13264 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13265 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013266 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13267
13268ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013269 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13270 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13271 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13272 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013273
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013274strict-sni
13275 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13276 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13277 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13278 See the "crt" option for more information.
13279
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013280tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013281 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013282 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
13283 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013284 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013285 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13286 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13287 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13288 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13289 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13290 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13291 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13292
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013293tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013294 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013295 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13296 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13297 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13298 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13299 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13300 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13301 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013302 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13303 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13304 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013305
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013306tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13307 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013308 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13309 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13310 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13311 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13312 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13313 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13314 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13315 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13316 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13317 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013318 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13319 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13320
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013321transparent
13322 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13323 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13324 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13325 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13326 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13327 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13328 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13329 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13330 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13331 so check for support with your vendor.
13332
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013333v4v6
13334 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13335 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13336 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13337 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013338 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013339
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013340v6only
13341 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13342 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13343 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013344 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13345 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013346
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013347uid <uid>
13348 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13349 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13350 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13351 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13352 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13353
13354user <user>
13355 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13356 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13357 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13358 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13359 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13360
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013361verify [none|optional|required]
13362 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13363 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13364 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13365 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13366 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013367 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13368 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13369 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13370 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013371
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200133725.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013373------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013374
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013375The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13376which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13377arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13378settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13379after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13380Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13381address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013382
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013383 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013384 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013385
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013386Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13387keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13388
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013389The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013390
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013391addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013392 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013393 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13394 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13395 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13396 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13397 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013398
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013399agent-check
13400 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013401 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013402 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13403 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13404 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013405
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013406 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013407 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013408 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13409 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13410 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013411
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013412 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13413 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13414 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13415 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13416 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013417
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013418 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013419 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013420
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013421 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13422 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13423 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013424
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013425 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13426 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13427 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013428
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013429 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013430 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13431 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13432 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13433 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013434 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013435 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013436
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013437 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13438 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013439
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013440 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13441 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13442 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13443 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13444 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13445 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13446 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13447 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13448 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013449
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013450 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13451 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013452 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13453 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13454 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013455 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013456
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013457 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013458 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013459
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013460agent-send <string>
13461 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13462 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13463 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13464 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13465 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13466
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013467agent-inter <delay>
13468 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13469 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13470
13471 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13472 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13473 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13474 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13475 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13476 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13477 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13478 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13479 of backends use the same servers.
13480
13481 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13482
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013483agent-addr <addr>
13484 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13485
13486 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13487 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13488 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13489 hostname, it will be resolved.
13490
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013491agent-port <port>
13492 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13493
13494 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13495
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013496allow-0rtt
13497 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013498 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13499 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013500
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013501alpn <protocols>
13502 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13503 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13504 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013505 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013506 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13507 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13508 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13509 now obsolete NPN extension.
13510 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13511 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13512
13513 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013515backup
13516 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13517 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13518 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13519 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013520 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13521 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013522
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013523ca-file <cafile>
13524 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13525 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13526 server's certificate.
13527
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013528check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013529 This option enables health checks on a server:
13530 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13531 considered available.
13532 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13533 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13534 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13535 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13536 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13537 set.
13538 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13539 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13540 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13541 exchanges succeed.
13542
13543 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13544 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13545 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13546 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13547 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013548 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013549 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13550
13551 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13552 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13553
13554 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13555 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13556
13557 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13558 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13559 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13560 available.
13561
13562 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13563 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13564 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13565
13566 Example:
13567 # simple tcp check
13568 backend foo
13569 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13570 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13571 backend foo
13572 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13573 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13574 backend foo
13575 option tcp-check
13576 tcp-check connect
13577 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013578
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013579check-send-proxy
13580 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13581 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13582 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13583 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13584 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13585 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13586 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13587
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013588check-alpn <protocols>
13589 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13590 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13591 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13592
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013593check-proto <name>
13594 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13595 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13596 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
13597 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013598 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013599 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13600 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13601
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013602check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013603 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013604 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13605 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013606
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013607check-ssl
13608 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13609 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13610 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13611 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013612 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013613 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13614 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013615 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013616 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13617 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013618
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013619check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013620 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013621 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13622 for normal traffic.
13623
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013624ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013625 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13626 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13627 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013628 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13629 information and recommendations see e.g.
13630 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13631 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13632 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013633
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013634ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13635 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13636 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13637 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13638 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013639 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13640 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13641 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013642
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013643cookie <value>
13644 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13645 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13646 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13647 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13648 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13649 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13650 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13651
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013652crl-file <crlfile>
13653 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13654 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13655 to verify server's certificate.
13656
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013657crt <cert>
13658 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13659 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13660 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13661 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13662 certificate request.
13663
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013664disabled
13665 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13666 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13667 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13668 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13669 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013670 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013671
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013672enabled
13673 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13674 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13675 default value.
13676 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13677 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013678
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013679error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013680 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13681 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13682 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013683
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013684 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013685
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013686fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013687 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13688 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13689 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13690
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013691force-sslv3
13692 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13693 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013694 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013695 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013696
13697force-tlsv10
13698 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013699 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013700 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013701
13702force-tlsv11
13703 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013704 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013705 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013706
13707force-tlsv12
13708 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013709 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013710 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013711
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013712force-tlsv13
13713 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13714 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013715 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013716
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013717id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013718 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13719 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13720 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013721
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013722init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13723 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13724 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013725 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013726 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13727 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13728 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13729 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13730 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13731 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13732 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13733 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13734 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013735 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013736 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13737 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13738 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13739 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13740 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13741 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013742 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013743
13744 Example:
13745 defaults
13746 # never fail on address resolution
13747 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13748
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013749inter <delay>
13750fastinter <delay>
13751downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013752 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13753 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13754 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13755 between checks depending on the server state :
13756
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013757 Server state | Interval used
13758 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13759 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13760 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13761 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13762 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13763 or yet unchecked. |
13764 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13765 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13766 | "inter" otherwise.
13767 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013768
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013769 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13770 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13771 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13772 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013773 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13774 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13775 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13776 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13777 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013778
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013779log-proto <logproto>
13780 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13781 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13782 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13783 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13784
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013785maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013786 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13787 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013788 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13789 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013790 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13791 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13792 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13793 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13794
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013795 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13796 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13797 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13798 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13799 than 50 concurrent requests.
13800
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013801maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013802 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13803 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13804 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13805 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020013806 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
13807 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
13808 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
13809 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
13810 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
13811 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
13812 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013813
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013814max-reuse <count>
13815 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13816 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13817 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13818 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13819 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13820 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13821 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13822 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13823
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013824minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013825 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13826 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13827 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13828 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13829 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13830 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013831 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013832 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013833
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013834namespace <name>
13835 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13836 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13837 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13838 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13839
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013840no-agent-check
13841 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13842 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13843 default value.
13844 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13845 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13846
13847no-backup
13848 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13849 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13850 default value.
13851 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13852 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13853
13854no-check
13855 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13856 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13857 default value.
13858 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13859 "default-server" "check" setting.
13860
13861no-check-ssl
13862 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13863 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13864 default value.
13865 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13866 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13867
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013868no-send-proxy
13869 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13870 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13871 default value.
13872 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13873 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13874
13875no-send-proxy-v2
13876 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13877 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13878 default value.
13879 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13880 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13881
13882no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13883 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13884 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13885 default value.
13886 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13887 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13888
13889no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13890 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13891 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13892 default value.
13893 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13894 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13895
13896no-ssl
13897 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13898 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13899 default value.
13900 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13901 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13902
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010013903 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
13904 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
13905 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
13906
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013907no-ssl-reuse
13908 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13909 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13910 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13911 and for paranoid users.
13912
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013913no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013914 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13915 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013916 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013917
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013918 Supported in default-server: No
13919
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013920no-tls-tickets
13921 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13922 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13923 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013924 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13925 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013926 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13927 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13928 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013929 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013930
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013931no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013932 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013933 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13934 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013935 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13936 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013937 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013938
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013939 Supported in default-server: No
13940
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013941no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013942 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013943 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13944 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013945 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13946 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013947 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013948
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013949 Supported in default-server: No
13950
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013951no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013952 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013953 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13954 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013955 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13956 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013957 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013958
13959 Supported in default-server: No
13960
13961no-tlsv13
13962 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13963 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13964 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13965 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13966 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013967 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013968
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013969 Supported in default-server: No
13970
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013971no-verifyhost
13972 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13973 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13974 default value.
13975 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13976 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013977
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013978no-tfo
13979 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13980 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13981 default value.
13982 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13983 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13984
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013985non-stick
13986 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13987 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13988 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13989
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013990npn <protocols>
13991 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13992 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13993 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013994 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013995 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13996 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13997 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13998
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013999observe <mode>
14000 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14001 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14002 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14003 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14004 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14005 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014006 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014007
14008 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14009
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014010on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014011 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14012 Currently, four modes are available:
14013 - fastinter: force fastinter
14014 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14015 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14016 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14017 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14018
14019 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14020
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014021on-marked-down <action>
14022 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14023 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014024 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14025 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14026 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14027 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14028 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14029 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14030 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14031 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014032
14033 Actions are disabled by default
14034
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014035on-marked-up <action>
14036 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14037 Currently one action is available:
14038 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14039 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14040 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14041 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014042 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14043 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014044 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14045 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14046
14047 Actions are disabled by default
14048
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014049pool-low-conn <max>
14050 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14051 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14052 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14053 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14054 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14055 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14056 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14057 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14058 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14059 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
14060 applying to "http-reuse".
14061
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014062pool-max-conn <max>
14063 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14064 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14065 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14066 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14067 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14068 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14069
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014070pool-purge-delay <delay>
14071 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014072 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014073 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014074
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014075port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014076 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014077 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14078 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14079 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14080 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14081 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014082
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014083proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014084 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14085 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14086 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
14087 reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014088 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014089 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14090
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014091redir <prefix>
14092 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14093 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14094 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14095 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14096 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14097 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14098 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14099 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014100 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014101 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014102 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14103 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14104 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14105 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14106
14107 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14108
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014109rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014110 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14111 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14112 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14113
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014114resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14115 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14116 server.
14117
14118 Available options:
14119
14120 * allow-dup-ip
14121 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14122 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14123 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14124 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14125 For such case, simply enable this option.
14126 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14127
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014128 * ignore-weight
14129 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14130 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14131 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14132
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014133 * prevent-dup-ip
14134 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14135 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14136 same fqdn.
14137 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14138
14139 Example:
14140 backend b_myapp
14141 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14142 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14143 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14144
14145 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14146 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14147 it
14148 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14149 different address
14150
14151 Default value: not set
14152
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014153resolve-prefer <family>
14154 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14155 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14156 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14157 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14158
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014159 Default value: ipv6
14160
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014161 Example:
14162
14163 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014164
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014165resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014166 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014167 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014168 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014169 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14170 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014171 configured network, another address is selected.
14172
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014173 Example:
14174
14175 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014176
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014177resolvers <id>
14178 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14179 hostname.
14180
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014181 Example:
14182
14183 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014184
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014185 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014186
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014187send-proxy
14188 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14189 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14190 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14191 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014192 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14193 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14194 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14195 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
14196 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
14197 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14198 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14199 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14200 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14201 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014202 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14203 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014204
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014205send-proxy-v2
14206 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14207 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14208 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14209 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014210 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14211 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14212 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14213 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014214
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014215proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014216 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14217 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14218
14219 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14220 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14221 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14222 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14223 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14224 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14225 connection is supported).
14226 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14227 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14228 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14229 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14230 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14231 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14232 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014233
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014234send-proxy-v2-ssl
14235 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14236 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14237 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14238 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14239 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14240 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14241 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014242 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14243 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014244
14245send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14246 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14247 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14248 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14249 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14250 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14251 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14252 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14253 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014254 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14255 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014256
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014257slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014258 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14259 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14260 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14261 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14262 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14263 parameters :
14264
14265 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14266 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14267
14268 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14269 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14270 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14271 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14272
14273 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
14274 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14275 seen as failed.
14276
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014277sni <expression>
14278 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14279 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14280 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14281 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014282 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14283 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014284 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014285 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14286 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014287
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014288source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014289source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014290source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014291 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14292 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14293 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14294 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14295
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014296 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14297 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14298 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14299 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14300 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14301 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14302 server.
14303
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014304 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14305 specifying the source address without port(s).
14306
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014307ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014308 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14309 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14310 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14311 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14312 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14313 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014314 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14315 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014316
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014317ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14318 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14319 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14320 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14321
14322ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14323 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14324 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14325 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14326
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014327ssl-reuse
14328 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14329 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14330 default value.
14331 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14332 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14333
14334stick
14335 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14336 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14337 default value.
14338 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14339 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014340
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014341socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014342 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014343 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14344 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14345
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014346tcp-ut <delay>
14347 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
14348 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
14349 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014350 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014351 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14352 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14353 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14354 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14355 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14356 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14357 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14358 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14359 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14360
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014361tfo
14362 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14363 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14364 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14365 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14366 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014367 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014368
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014369track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014370 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14371 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14372 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14373 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014374 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14375
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014376tls-tickets
14377 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14378 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14379 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014380 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14381 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14382 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014383 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014384 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014385
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014386verify [none|required]
14387 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014388 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014389 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14390 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014391 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014392 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14393 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14394 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14395 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14396 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14397 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14398 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14399 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014400
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014401verifyhost <hostname>
14402 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014403 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14404 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14405 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14406 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14407 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14408 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14409 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14410 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014411
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014412weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014413 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14414 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14415 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014416 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14417 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14418 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14419 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14420 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14421 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014422
14423
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200144245.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14425-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014426
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014427HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14428using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070014429configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014430This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14431can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14432workload.
14433This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14434resolution at run time.
14435Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14436carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14437
14438
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200144395.3.1. Global overview
14440----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014441
14442As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14443different steps of the process life:
14444
14445 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14446 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14447 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14448
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014449 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14450 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014451
14452A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14453 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14454 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14455 resolution to know this new IP.
14456
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014457When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014458HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014459SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14460from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14461will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14462will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014463
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014464A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014465 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014466 first valid response.
14467
14468 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14469 servers return an error.
14470
14471
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200144725.3.2. The resolvers section
14473----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014474
14475This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014476HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14477contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014478
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014479When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14480uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14481is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14482answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14483
14484When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014485used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014486
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014487 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14488 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14489 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014490
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014491 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14492 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014493
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014494 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14495 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14496 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014497
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014498For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14499following scenarios are possible:
14500
14501 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14502 ignored
14503
14504 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14505 applied
14506
14507 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14508 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14509
14510 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14511 retries the query with a new type
14512
14513 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14514 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014515
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014516As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14517a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014518<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014519
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014520
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014521resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014522 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014523
14524A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14525
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014526accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014527 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014528 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014529 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14530 by RFC 6891)
14531
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014532 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
14533
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014534nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
14535 DNS server description:
14536 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
14537 <ip> : IP address of the server
14538 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
14539
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014540parse-resolv-conf
14541 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14542 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14543 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14544
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014545hold <status> <period>
14546 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14547 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014548 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014549 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014550 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14551 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14552 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14553
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014554 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014555
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014556resolve_retries <nb>
14557 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
14558 giving up.
14559 Default value: 3
14560
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014561 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
14562 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
14563 type.
14564
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014565timeout <event> <time>
14566 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
14567 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
14568 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014569 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
14570 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014571 Default value: 1s
14572 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014573 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014574 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014575 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14576 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
14577
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014578 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014579
14580 resolvers mydns
14581 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
14582 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014583 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014584 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014585 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014586 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014587 hold other 30s
14588 hold refused 30s
14589 hold nx 30s
14590 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014591 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014592 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014593
14594
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200145956. Cache
14596---------
14597
14598HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14599(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14600RAM.
14601
14602The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14603this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14604
14605If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14606independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14607when we try to allocate a new one.
14608
14609The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14610
14611It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
14612"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
14613for more details.
14614
14615When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
14616replaced by "<CACHE>".
14617
14618
146196.1. Limitation
14620----------------
14621
14622The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
14623
14624- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010014625- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
14626 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
14627 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014628- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
14629- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010014630- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
14631 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
14632 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010014633- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
14634 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010014635- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
14636 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
14637 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014638
14639- If the request is not a GET
14640- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
14641- If the request contains an Authorization header
14642
14643
146446.2. Setup
14645-----------
14646
14647To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
14648the corresponding http-request and response actions.
14649
14650
146516.2.1. Cache section
14652---------------------
14653
14654cache <name>
14655 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14656 size of cache is mandatory.
14657
14658total-max-size <megabytes>
14659 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14660 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14661
14662max-object-size <bytes>
14663 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14664 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14665 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14666
14667max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010014668 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014669 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
14670 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
14671 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
14672 default.
14673
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010014674process-vary <on/off>
14675 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010014676 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
14677 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
14678 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010014679 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010014680
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010014681max-secondary-entries <number>
14682 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
14683 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
14684 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
14685
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014686
146876.2.2. Proxy section
14688---------------------
14689
14690http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14691 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14692 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14693 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14694 after this one.
14695
14696http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14697 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14698 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14699 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14700 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14701
14702
14703Example:
14704
14705 backend bck1
14706 mode http
14707
14708 http-request cache-use foobar
14709 http-response cache-store foobar
14710 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14711
14712 cache foobar
14713 total-max-size 4
14714 max-age 240
14715
14716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200147177. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14718----------------------------------
14719
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014720HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014721client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14722The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14723these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14724but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14725data called patterns.
14726
14727
147287.1. ACL basics
14729---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014730
14731The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14732content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14733from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14734simple :
14735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014736 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014737 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014738 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14739 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014741The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14742adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014743
14744In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014746 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014747
14748This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14749Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14750and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014751an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14752conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14753as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14754are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014755
14756ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14757'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14758which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14759
14760There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14761performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014763The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14764specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14765this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014766methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14767ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014768
14769Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14770 - boolean
14771 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14772 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14773 - string
14774 - data block
14775
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014776Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14777converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14778would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14779The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14780which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14781
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014782Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14783keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14784fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14785which are summarized in the table below :
14786
14787 +---------------------+-----------------+
14788 | Sample or converter | Default |
14789 | output type | matching method |
14790 +---------------------+-----------------+
14791 | boolean | bool |
14792 +---------------------+-----------------+
14793 | integer | int |
14794 +---------------------+-----------------+
14795 | ip | ip |
14796 +---------------------+-----------------+
14797 | string | str |
14798 +---------------------+-----------------+
14799 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14800 +---------------------+-----------------+
14801
14802Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14803matching method, see below.
14804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014805The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14806 - boolean
14807 - integer or integer range
14808 - IP address / network
14809 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14810 - regular expression
14811 - hex block
14812
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014813The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14814
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014815 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14816 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014817 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014818 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014819 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014820 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014821 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014823The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14824read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14825if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14826lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14827will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14828beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14829a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14830lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14831exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14832
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014833The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14834parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14835ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14836a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14837check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14838
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014839The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14840socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14841file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014843Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14844loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14845
14846 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14847
14848In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14849the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14850case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14851as well.
14852
14853The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14854sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14855do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14856methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14857is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014858obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014859followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14860default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14861that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14862string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14863
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014864The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14865By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14866string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14867resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14868server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014869waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014870flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14871function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014873There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14874sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14875be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014876
14877 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14878 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014879 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14880 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14881 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14882 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014883
14884 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14885 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014886 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014887
14888 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014889 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014890
14891 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014892 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014893
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014894 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014895 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14896
14897 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14898 binary or string samples.
14899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014900 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14901 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014903 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14904 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14905 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014907 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14908 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014910 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14911 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014913 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14914 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014916 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14917 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014918 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014920 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14921 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14922 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014923
14924For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14925request, it is possible to do :
14926
14927 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14928
14929In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14930buffer, one would use the following acl :
14931
14932 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14933
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014934On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14935possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14936
14937 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014939All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14940criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14941method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14942to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14943criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14944the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014946If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014947the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14948For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014950 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14951 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14952 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14953 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014954
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014955
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014956The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14957types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14958combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14959brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14960default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014962 +-------------------------------------------------+
14963 | Input sample type |
14964 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014965 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014966 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14967 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14968 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014969 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014970 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014971 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014972 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014973 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014974 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014975 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014976 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014977 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014978 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014979 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014980 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014981 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014982 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014983 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014984 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014985 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014986 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014987 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014988 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014989 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014990 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14991 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14992 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014993
14994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149957.1.1. Matching booleans
14996------------------------
14997
14998In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14999Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15000When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15001that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15002
15003Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15004return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15005"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15006
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200150087.1.2. Matching integers
15009------------------------
15010
15011Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15012enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15013to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15014
15015Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15016matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15017lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015018
15019For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15020unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15021representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15022
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015023As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15024two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15025instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15026ranges and operators.
15027
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015028For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015029operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15030Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15031of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015032
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015033Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015034
15035 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15036 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15037 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15038 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15039 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15040
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015041For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015042
15043 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15044
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015045This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15046
15047 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15048
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200150507.1.3. Matching strings
15051-----------------------
15052
15053String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15054different forms :
15055
15056 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015057 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015058
15059 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015060 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015061
15062 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15063 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15064
15065 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15066 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15067
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015068 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015069 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15070 matches.
15071
15072 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15073 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15074 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015075
15076String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15077exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15078characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15079string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15080to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015081before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015082
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015083Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15084(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15085Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15086
15087Example:
15088 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15089 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15090
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200150927.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15093---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015094
15095Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15096they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15097possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15098passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15099the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015100the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15101match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015102
15103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200151047.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15105-------------------------------------
15106
15107It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15108not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15109a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15110to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15111digits may be used upper or lower case.
15112
15113Example :
15114 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15115 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15116
15117
151187.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15119---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015120
15121IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15122netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15123within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015124host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015125difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15126at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15127does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15128parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015129
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015130The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15131abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15132
15133 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15134 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15135 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15136 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15137 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15138 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15139 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15140 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15141
15142Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15143192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15144
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015145IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15146Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15147trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15148IPv6 patterns.
15149
15150HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15151following situations :
15152 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15153 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15154 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15155 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15156 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15157 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15158 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15159 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15160 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15161 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015163
151647.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15165----------------------------------
15166
15167Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15168combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15169
15170 - AND (implicit)
15171 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15172 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015174A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015176 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015178Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15179indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015181For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15182"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15183requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15184is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15185
15186 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015187 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15188 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15189 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015190
15191To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15192and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15193
15194 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15195 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15196 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15197 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15198
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015199 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015200 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15201 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15202 use_backend www if host_www
15203
15204It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15205expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15206be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15207the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15208
15209 The following rule :
15210
15211 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015212 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015213
15214 Can also be written that way :
15215
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015216 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015217
15218It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15219to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15220simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15221sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15222good use is the following :
15223
15224 With named ACLs :
15225
15226 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15227 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15228 monitor fail if site_dead
15229
15230 With anonymous ACLs :
15231
15232 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15233
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015234See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15235keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015236
15237
152387.3. Fetching samples
15239---------------------
15240
15241Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15242against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15243sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15244ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15245of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15246available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15247
15248This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15249Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15250compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15251deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15252
15253The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15254matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15255method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15256indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15257
15258As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15259when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15260mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15261the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15262ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15263
15264Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15265multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15266when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015267incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15268are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015269is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15270all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15271
15272Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15273 - name
15274 - name(arg1)
15275 - name(arg1,arg2)
15276
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015277
152787.3.1. Converters
15279-----------------
15280
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015281Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15282of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15283is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15284was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015285has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015286unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15287
15288These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15289sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15290the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015291support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015292
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015293A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15294support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15295supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15296(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15297bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015299The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015300
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001530151d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15302 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15303 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15304 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15305 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15306 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15307
15308 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015309 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15310 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015311 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15312 frontend http-in
15313 bind *:8081
15314 default_backend servers
15315 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15316 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15317
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015318add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015319 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015320 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015321 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
15322 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015323 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015324 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15325 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15326 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15327 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015328 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015329 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015330
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010015331aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
15332 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
15333 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
15334 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
15335 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
15336 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
15337 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
15338
15339 Example:
15340 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
15341 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
15342
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015343and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015344 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015345 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015346 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15347 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015348 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015349 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15350 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15351 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15352 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015353 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015354 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015355
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015356b64dec
15357 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15358 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
15359
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015360base64
15361 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015362 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015363 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
15364
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015365bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015366 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015367 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015368 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015369 presence of a flag).
15370
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015371bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
15372 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
15373 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015374 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015375
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015376concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15377 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15378 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15379 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15380 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15381 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15382 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15383 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15384 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15385 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15386 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015387 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015388 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015389 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15390 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015391
15392 Example:
15393 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15394 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15395 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015396 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015397 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15398
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015399cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015400 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15401 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015402
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015403crc32([<avalanche>])
15404 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15405 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15406 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15407 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15408 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15409 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15410 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15411 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15412 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15413 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015414 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15415
15416crc32c([<avalanche>])
15417 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15418 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15419 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15420 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15421 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15422 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15423 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15424 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015425
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015426cut_crlf
15427 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15428 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15429 updated.
15430
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015431da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015432 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15433 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15434 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15435 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015436 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015437 configuration language.
15438
15439 Example:
15440 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015441 bind *:8881
15442 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015443 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015444
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015445debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15446 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15447 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15448 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15449 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15450 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15451 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15452 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15453 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15454 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15455 printable sample types.
15456
15457 Example:
15458 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015459
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015460digest(<algorithm>)
15461 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15462 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15463
15464 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15465 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15466
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015467div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015468 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15469 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015470 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015471 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15472 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015473 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015474 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15475 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15476 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15477 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015478 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015479 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015480
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015481djb2([<avalanche>])
15482 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15483 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15484 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15485 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15486 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15487 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15488 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015489 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15490 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015491
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015492even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015493 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015494 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15495
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015496field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15497 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15498 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15499 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15500 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
15501 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
15502 fields.
15503
15504 Example :
15505 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15506 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15507 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15508 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15509 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015510
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015511fix_is_valid
15512 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
15513 Information eXchange):
15514
15515 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
15516 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050015517 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015518 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
15519 - checks the MstType tag is the third tag.
15520 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
15521 checksum
15522
15523 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15524 the server can be parsed.
15525
15526 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
15527 message, false if not.
15528
15529 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
15530
15531 Example:
15532 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15533 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15534
15535fix_tag_value(<tag>)
15536 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
15537 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
15538 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
15539 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
15540 MsgType, SenderComID, TargetComID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
15541 added.
15542
15543 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15544 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
15545 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
15546 fix_is_valid converter.
15547
15548 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
15549
15550 Example:
15551 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15552 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15553 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
15554 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
15555 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
15556
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015557hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015558 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015559 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015560 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015561 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010015562
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015563hex2i
15564 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015565 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015566
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020015567htonl
15568 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
15569 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
15570 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
15571 unsigned 32-bit integer.
15572
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010015573hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015574 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
15575 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
15576 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
15577 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
15578
15579 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15580 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15581
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015582http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015583 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15584 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015585 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
15586 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
15587 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
15588 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
15589 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
15590 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
15591 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
15592 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015593
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015594iif(<true>,<false>)
15595 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
15596 string otherwise.
15597
15598 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020015599 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015600
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015601in_table(<table>)
15602 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15603 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
15604 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015605 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015606 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
15607
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010015608ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015609 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015610 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015611 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
15612 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
15613 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
15614 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
15615 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015616
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015617json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015618 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015619 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015620 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015621 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
15622 of errors:
15623 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
15624 bytes, ...)
15625 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
15626 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
15627
15628 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
15629 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
15630 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
15631 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
15632 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
15633 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015634 - "ascii" : never fails;
15635 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
15636 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015637 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015638 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015639 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
15640 characters corresponding to the other errors.
15641
15642 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015643 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015644
15645 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015646 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015647 capture request header user-agent len 150
15648 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015649
15650 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
15651 GET / HTTP/1.0
15652 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
15653
15654 Output log:
15655 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
15656
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015657language(<value>[,<default>])
15658 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
15659 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
15660 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
15661 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
15662 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
15663 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
15664 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
15665 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
15666 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015667 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015668 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
15669 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015670
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015671 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015672
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015673 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
15674 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015675
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015676 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
15677 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
15678 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
15679 use_backend spanish if es
15680 use_backend french if fr
15681 use_backend english if en
15682 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015683
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010015684length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010015685 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
15686 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15687 type. The result is of type integer.
15688
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015689lower
15690 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
15691 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15692 type. The result is of type string.
15693
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015694ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
15695 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15696 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
15697 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15698 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15699 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15700 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
15701
15702 Example :
15703
15704 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015705 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015706 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15707
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020015708ltrim(<chars>)
15709 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
15710 representation of the input sample.
15711
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015712map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15713map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15714map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15715 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
15716 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
15717 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
15718 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
15719 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
15720 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
15721 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
15722 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015723
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015724 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
15725 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
15726 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015727
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015728 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015729 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015730
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015731 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
15732 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15733 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
15734 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020015735 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
15736 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015737 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
15738 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15739 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
15740 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15741 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
15742 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15743 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
15744 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015745 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15746 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15747 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015748 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15749 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15750 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15751 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15752 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015753
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015754 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15755 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15756 the corresponding match text.
15757
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015758 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15759 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15760 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15761 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15762 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015763
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015764 Example :
15765
15766 # this is a comment and is ignored
15767 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15768 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15769 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15770 | | | `---------- value
15771 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15772 | `---------------------------- key
15773 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15774
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015775mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015776 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15777 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015778 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015779 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015780 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015781 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15782 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15783 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15784 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015785 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015786 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015787
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010015788mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname or property ID>)
15789 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
15790 <packettype>.
15791 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
15792 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
15793 from.
15794 Supported string and integers can be found here:
15795 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
15796 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
15797
15798 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
15799 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
15800 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
15801 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
15802
15803 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
15804 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
15805 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
15806 packets only):
15807 17: Session Expiry Interval
15808 33: Receive Maximum
15809 39: Maximum Packet Size
15810 34: Topic Alias Maximum
15811 25: Request Response Information
15812 23: Request Problem Information
15813 21: Authentication Method
15814 22: Authentication Data
15815 18: Will Delay Interval
15816 1: Payload Format Indicator
15817 2: Message Expiry Interval
15818 3: Content Type
15819 8: Response Topic
15820 9: Correlation Data
15821 Not supported yet:
15822 38: User Property
15823
15824 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
15825 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
15826 packets only):
15827 17: Session Expiry Interval
15828 33: Receive Maximum
15829 36: Maximum QoS
15830 37: Retain Available
15831 39: Maximum Packet Size
15832 18: Assigned Client Identifier
15833 34: Topic Alias Maximum
15834 31: Reason String
15835 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
15836 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
15837 42: Shared Subscription Available
15838 19: Server Keep Alive
15839 26: Response Information
15840 28: Server Reference
15841 21: Authentication Method
15842 22: Authentication Data
15843 Not supported yet:
15844 38: User Property
15845
15846 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15847 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
15848 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
15849 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
15850
15851 Example:
15852
15853 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
15854 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
15855 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
15856 if data_in_buffer
15857 # do the same as above
15858 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
15859 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
15860 if data_in_buffer
15861
15862mqtt_is_valid
15863 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
15864
15865 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15866 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
15867 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
15868 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
15869
15870 Example:
15871
15872 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
15873 tcp-request content reject unless req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid
15874
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015875mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015876 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015877 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15878 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015879 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015880 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015881 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015882 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15883 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15884 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15885 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015886 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015887 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015888
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015889nbsrv
15890 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15891 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15892 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15893 map lookup.
15894
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015895neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015896 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15897 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15898 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15899 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015900
15901not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015902 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015903 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015904 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015905 absence of a flag).
15906
15907odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015908 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015909 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15910
15911or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015912 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015913 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015914 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15915 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015916 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015917 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15918 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15919 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15920 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015921 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015922 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015923
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015924protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15925 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15926 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15927 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15928 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15929 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15930 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15931 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15932 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15933 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15934 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15935 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15936
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015937regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015938 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15939 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15940 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15941 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15942 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15943 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15944 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15945 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15946 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015947 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15948 of characters with other ones.
15949
15950 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15951 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15952 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15953 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15954 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15955 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015956
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015957 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015958
15959 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15960 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15961 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015962 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015963
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015964 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15965 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15966
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015967 # capture groups and backreferences
15968 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020015969 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015970 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15971
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015972capture-req(<id>)
15973 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15974 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15975
15976 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015977 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15978 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015979
15980capture-res(<id>)
15981 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
15982 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15983
15984 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015985 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15986 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015987
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020015988rtrim(<chars>)
15989 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
15990 of the input sample.
15991
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015992sdbm([<avalanche>])
15993 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
15994 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15995 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15996 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15997 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15998 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15999 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016000 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16001 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016002
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016003secure_memcmp(<var>)
16004 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16005 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16006 match.
16007
16008 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16009 performed in constant time.
16010
16011 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16012 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16013
16014 Example :
16015
16016 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16017 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16018 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16019 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16020
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016021set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016022 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16023 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16024 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016025 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016026 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16027 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016028 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016029 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16030 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016031 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016032 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016033
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016034sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016035 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016036 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16037
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016038sha2([<bits>])
16039 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16040 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16041
16042 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16043 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16044
16045 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16046 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16047
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016048srv_queue
16049 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16050 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16051 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16052 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16053 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16054
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016055strcmp(<var>)
16056 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16057 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16058 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16059 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16060 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16061 shorter).
16062
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016063 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16064 strings in constant time.
16065
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016066 Example :
16067
16068 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16069 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16070 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16071
16072
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016073sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016074 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16075 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016076 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016077 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16078 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016079 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016080 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16081 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016082 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016083 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16084 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016085 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016086 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016087
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016088table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16089 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16090 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16091 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16092 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16093 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16094 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16095
16096
16097table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16098 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16099 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16100 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16101 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16102 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16103 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16104
16105table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16106 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16107 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016108 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016109 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16110 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16111
16112table_conn_cur(<table>)
16113 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16114 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16115 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16116 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16117 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16118
16119table_conn_rate(<table>)
16120 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16121 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16122 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16123 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16124 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16125
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016126table_gpt0(<table>)
16127 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16128 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16129 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16130 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16131 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16132
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016133table_gpc0(<table>)
16134 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16135 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16136 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16137 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16138 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16139
16140table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16141 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16142 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16143 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16144 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16145 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16146 sample fetch keyword.
16147
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016148table_gpc1(<table>)
16149 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16150 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16151 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16152 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16153 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16154
16155table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16156 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16157 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16158 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16159 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16160 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16161 sample fetch keyword.
16162
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016163table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16164 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16165 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016166 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016167 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16168 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16169
16170table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16171 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16172 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16173 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16174 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16175 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16176 keyword.
16177
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016178table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16179 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16180 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16181 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16182 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16183 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16184
16185table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16186 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16187 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16188 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16189 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16190 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16191 keyword.
16192
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016193table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16194 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16195 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016196 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016197 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16198 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16199
16200table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16201 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16202 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16203 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16204 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16205 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16206 keyword.
16207
16208table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16209 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16210 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016211 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016212 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16213 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16214 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16215 keyword.
16216
16217table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16218 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16219 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016220 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016221 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16222 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16223 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16224 keyword.
16225
16226table_server_id(<table>)
16227 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16228 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16229 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
16230 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
16231 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
16232 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
16233
16234table_sess_cnt(<table>)
16235 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16236 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016237 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016238 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
16239 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16240 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
16241 keyword.
16242
16243table_sess_rate(<table>)
16244 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16245 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16246 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
16247 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
16248 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16249 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
16250 keyword.
16251
16252table_trackers(<table>)
16253 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16254 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16255 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16256 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
16257 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
16258 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
16259 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
16260 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
16261 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
16262 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
16263
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016264upper
16265 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
16266 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16267 type. The result is of type string.
16268
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020016269url_dec([<in_form>])
16270 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
16271 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
16272 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
16273 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
16274 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
16275 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020016276
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010016277url_enc([<enc_type>])
16278 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
16279 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
16280 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
16281 optional argument is here for future changes.
16282
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016283ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016284 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016285 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
16286 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
16287 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016288 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16289 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16290 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16291 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016292 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016293 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16294 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016295
16296 Example:
16297 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
16298 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
16299
16300 message Point {
16301 int32 latitude = 1;
16302 int32 longitude = 2;
16303 }
16304
16305 message PPoint {
16306 Point point = 59;
16307 }
16308
16309 message Rectangle {
16310 // One corner of the rectangle.
16311 PPoint lo = 48;
16312 // The other corner of the rectangle.
16313 PPoint hi = 49;
16314 }
16315
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016316 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16317 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
16318 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016319
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016320 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16321 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016322 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016323 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16324
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016325 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016326
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016327 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016328
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016329 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
16330 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16331 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016332
16333 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
16334 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
16335 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
16336
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016337 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
16338 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
16339 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016340
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016341
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016342unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010016343 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
16344 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
16345 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
16346 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16347 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
16348 response),
16349 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16350 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
16351 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
16352 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
16353
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016354utime(<format>[,<offset>])
16355 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16356 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
16357 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16358 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16359 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16360 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
16361
16362 Example :
16363
16364 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016365 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016366 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16367
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016368word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16369 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
16370 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
16371 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016372 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016373 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
16374 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
16375
16376 Example :
16377 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
16378 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16379 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
16380 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
16381 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016382 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010016383
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016384wt6([<avalanche>])
16385 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
16386 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16387 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16388 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16389 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16390 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16391 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016392 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
16393 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016394
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016395xor(<value>)
16396 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016397 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016398 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016399 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016400 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016401 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16402 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016403 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016404 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16405 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016406 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016407 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016408
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010016409xxh3([<seed>])
16410 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
16411 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
16412 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
16413 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
16414 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
16415 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
16416 considered as cryptographically secure.
16417
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010016418xxh32([<seed>])
16419 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
16420 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16421 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16422 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16423 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16424 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16425 as cryptographically secure.
16426
16427xxh64([<seed>])
16428 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
16429 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16430 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16431 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16432 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16433 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16434 as cryptographically secure.
16435
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016436
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200164377.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016438--------------------------------------------
16439
16440A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
16441not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
16442"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
16443The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
16444
16445always_false : boolean
16446 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16447 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16448
16449always_true : boolean
16450 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16451 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16452
16453avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016454 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016455 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
16456 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
16457 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
16458 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
16459 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
16460 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
16461 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
16462 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
16463 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
16464 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
16465 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
16466 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
16467 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010016468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016469be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016470 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
16471 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
16472 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
16473 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016474 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
16475
16476be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
16477 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16478 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
16479 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
16480 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
16481 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016482 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
16483 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016484
16485 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
16486 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
16487 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016489be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
16490 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16491 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16492 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016493 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016494 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
16495 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016496
16497 Example :
16498 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
16499 backend dynamic
16500 mode http
16501 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
16502 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016503
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016504bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016505 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
16506 of the string.
16507
16508bool(<bool>) : bool
16509 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
16510 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
16511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016512connslots([<backend>]) : integer
16513 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016514 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016515 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
16516 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050016517
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016518 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016519 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016520 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
16521
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016522 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
16523 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016524
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016525 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016526 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016527 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016528 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016529 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016530 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016531 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016532
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016533 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
16534 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016535 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016536 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016537
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016538cpu_calls : integer
16539 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
16540 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
16541 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
16542 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
16543 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
16544 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
16545
16546cpu_ns_avg : integer
16547 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16548 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16549 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16550 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16551 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16552 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16553 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
16554 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
16555 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
16556 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
16557 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
16558
16559cpu_ns_tot : integer
16560 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16561 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16562 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16563 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16564 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16565 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16566 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
16567 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
16568 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
16569 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
16570 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
16571 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
16572 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
16573
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016574date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016575 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016576
16577 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
16578 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
16579 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016580 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
16581
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016582 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
16583 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
16584 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
16585 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
16586 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
16587
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016588 Example :
16589
16590 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
16591 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016592
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016593 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
16594 # millisecond granularity
16595 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
16596
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010016597date_us : integer
16598 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
16599 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
16600 from the same timeval structure.
16601
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020016602distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
16603 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
16604 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
16605 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
16606 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
16607 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
16608 list of supported tokens.
16609
16610distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
16611 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
16612 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
16613 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
16614 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
16615 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
16616 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
16617 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
16618 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
16619 supported tokens.
16620
16621 Example :
16622 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
16623 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
16624 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
16625 # send large files to the big farm
16626 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
16627
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020016628env(<name>) : string
16629 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
16630 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
16631 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
16632 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
16633 certain way.
16634
16635 Examples :
16636 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
16637 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
16638
16639 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
16640 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
16641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016642fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
16643 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016644 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
16645 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016646 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
16647 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016648 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016649 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
16650 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016651
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020016652fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16653 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
16654 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
16655 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
16656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016657fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16658 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16659 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16660 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
16661 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
16662 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
16663 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
16664 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
16665 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016666
16667 Example :
16668 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
16669 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
16670 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
16671 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
16672 frontend mail
16673 bind :25
16674 mode tcp
16675 maxconn 100
16676 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
16677 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
16678 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
16679 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016680
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010016681hostname : string
16682 Returns the system hostname.
16683
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016684int(<integer>) : signed integer
16685 Returns a signed integer.
16686
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016687ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
16688 Returns an ipv4.
16689
16690ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
16691 Returns an ipv6.
16692
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016693lat_ns_avg : integer
16694 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16695 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16696 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16697 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16698 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16699 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16700 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16701 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16702 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016703 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16704 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16705 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16706 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16707 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
16708 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016709
16710lat_ns_tot : integer
16711 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16712 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16713 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16714 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16715 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16716 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16717 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16718 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16719 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016720 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16721 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16722 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16723 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16724 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016725 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
16726 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
16727 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
16728 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
16729 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
16730 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
16731
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016732meth(<method>) : method
16733 Returns a method.
16734
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016735nbproc : integer
16736 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
16737 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
16738 and debugging purposes.
16739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016740nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
16741 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
16742 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
16743 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016744 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
16745 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
16746 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016747
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040016748prio_class : integer
16749 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
16750 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
16751 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
16752
16753prio_offset : integer
16754 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
16755 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
16756 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
16757 set-priority-offset".
16758
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016759proc : integer
16760 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
16761 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
16762 debugging purposes.
16763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016764queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016765 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
16766 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
16767 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016768 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
16769 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
16770 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
16771 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
16772 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
16773
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010016774rand([<range>]) : integer
16775 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
16776 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
16777 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
16778 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
16779 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
16780
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020016781uuid([<version>]) : string
16782 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
16783 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
16784 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
16785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016786srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16787 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16788 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
16789 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
16790 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
16791 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016792 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
16793 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
16794
16795srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16796 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16797 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
16798 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16799 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
16800 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
16801 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
16802 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
16803
16804 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
16805 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016806
16807srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
16808 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
16809 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
16810 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016811 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016812 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
16813 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
16814 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
16815
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020016816srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16817 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
16818 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16819 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
16820 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
16821 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
16822 fetch methods.
16823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016824srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16825 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16826 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016827 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016828 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
16829 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016830 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016831 overloading servers).
16832
16833 Example :
16834 # Redirect to a separate back
16835 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
16836 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
16837 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
16838
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020016839srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16840 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
16841 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
16842 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
16843
16844srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16845 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
16846 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16847 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
16848
16849srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16850 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
16851 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16852 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
16853
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016854stopping : boolean
16855 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
16856 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
16857 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
16858
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016859str(<string>) : string
16860 Returns a string.
16861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016862table_avl([<table>]) : integer
16863 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
16864 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
16865
16866table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16867 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
16868 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
16869 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
16870
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010016871thread : integer
16872 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
16873 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
16874 and debugging purposes.
16875
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016876var(<var-name>) : undefined
16877 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016878 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16879 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016880 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016881 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16882 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016883 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016884 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16885 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016886 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016887 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016888
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200168897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016890----------------------------------
16891
16892The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16893closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
16894methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
16895sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
16896TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016897the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
16898counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016899"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16900used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16901can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16902Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16903table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16904tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16905currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016906
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016907bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016908 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16909 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16910 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016912be_id : integer
16913 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016914 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16915 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016916
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016917be_name : string
16918 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016919 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16920 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016921
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010016922be_server_timeout : integer
16923 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
16924 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
16925 also the "cur_server_timeout".
16926
16927be_tunnel_timeout : integer
16928 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
16929 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
16930 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
16931
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010016932cur_server_timeout : integer
16933 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
16934 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
16935 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
16936
16937cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
16938 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
16939 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
16940 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
16941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016942dst : ip
16943 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
16944 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
16945 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
16946 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016947 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
16948 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
16949 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
16950 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
16951 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
16952 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016953
16954dst_conn : integer
16955 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16956 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
16957 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
16958 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
16959 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
16960 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
16961 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
16962 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016963
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016964dst_is_local : boolean
16965 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16966 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16967 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16968 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016969 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016970 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16971 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16972 it only once per connection.
16973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016974dst_port : integer
16975 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16976 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16977 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16978 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16979 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16980 an HTTP header.
16981
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020016982fc_http_major : integer
16983 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16984 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16985 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
16986
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020016987fc_pp_authority : string
16988 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16989 if any.
16990
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010016991fc_pp_unique_id : string
16992 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16993 if any.
16994
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010016995fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
16996 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
16997 header.
16998
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020016999fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17000 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17001 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17002 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17003 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17004 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17005 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17006
17007fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17008 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17009 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17010 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17011 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17012 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17013 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17014
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017015fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017016 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17017 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17018 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17019 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17020
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017021fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017022 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17023 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17024 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17025 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17026
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017027fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017028 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17029 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17030 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17031 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17032
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017033fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017034 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17035 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17036 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17037 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17038
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017039fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017040 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17041 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17042 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17043 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17044
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017045fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017046 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17047 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17048 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17049 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17050
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017051fe_defbe : string
17052 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17053 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017055fe_id : integer
17056 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017057 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017058 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17059
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017060fe_name : string
17061 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17062 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17063 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17064
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017065fe_client_timeout : integer
17066 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17067 current frontend.
17068
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017069sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017070sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17071sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17072sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017073 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17074 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17075 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17076
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017077sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017078sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17079sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17080sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017081 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17082 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17083 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17084
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017085sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017086sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17087sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17088sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017089 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17090 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017091 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17092 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17093 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017094
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017095 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017096 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17097 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017098 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17099 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17100 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017101 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17102 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17103
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017104sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17105sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17106sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17107sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17108 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17109 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17110 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17111 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17112 when a first ACL was verified.
17113
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017114sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017115sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17116sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17117sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017118 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017119 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17120
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017121sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017122sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17123sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17124sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017125 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17126 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17127 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17128
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017129sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017130sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17131sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17132sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017133 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17134 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17135 See also src_conn_rate.
17136
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017137sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017138sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17139sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17140sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017141 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017142 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017143
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017144sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17145sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17146sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17147sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17148 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17149 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17150
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017151sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17152sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17153sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17154sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17155 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17156 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17157
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017158sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017159sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17160sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17161sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017162 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17163 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17164 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017165 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17166 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17167 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017168
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017169sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17170sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17171sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17172sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17173 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17174 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17175 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17176 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17177 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17178 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17179
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017180sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017181sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17182sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17183sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017184 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017185 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17186 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17187
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017188sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017189sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17190sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17191sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017192 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
17193 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17194 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
17195 src_http_err_rate.
17196
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017197sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17198sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17199sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17200sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17201 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
17202 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
17203 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
17204
17205sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17206sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17207sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17208sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17209 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
17210 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
17211 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
17212 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
17213
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017214sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017215sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17216sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17217sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017218 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017219 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17220 src_http_req_cnt.
17221
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017222sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017223sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17224sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17225sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017226 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
17227 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
17228 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17229 src_http_req_rate.
17230
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017231sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017232sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17233sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17234sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017235 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017236 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17237 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17238 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17239 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017240
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017241 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017242 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17243 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017244 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17245
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017246sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17247sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17248sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17249sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17250 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
17251 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17252 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17253 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17254 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
17255
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017256sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017257sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17258sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17259sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017260 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
17261 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17262 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017263
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017264sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017265sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17266sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17267sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017268 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
17269 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17270 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017271
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017272sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017273sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17274sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17275sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017276 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017277 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
17278 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
17279 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017280 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017281 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
17282
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017283sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017284sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17285sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17286sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017287 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
17288 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17289 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
17290 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
17291 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017292 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017293
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017294sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017295sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17296sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17297sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020017298 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
17299 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
17300 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
17301
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017302sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017303sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17304sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17305sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017306 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17307 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017308 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017309 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
17310 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017311 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
17312 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
17313 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017315so_id : integer
17316 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
17317 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
17318 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017319
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010017320so_name : string
17321 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
17322 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
17323 strings instead of integers.
17324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017325src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017326 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017327 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
17328 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
17329 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017330 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
17331 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
17332 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017333 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
17334 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
17335 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
17336 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
17337 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
17338 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
17339 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017340
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017341 Example:
17342 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
17343 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
17344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017345src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17346 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
17347 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
17348 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017349 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017351src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17352 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
17353 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017354 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017355 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017357src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17358 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17359 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17360 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17361 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17362 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17363 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017364
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017365 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017366 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17367 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
17368 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
17369 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017370 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017371 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17372 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17373
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017374src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17375 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17376 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17377 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17378 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17379 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17380 was verified.
17381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017382src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017383 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017384 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017385 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017386 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017388src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017389 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017390 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17391 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017392 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017394src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17395 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
17396 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17397 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017398 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017400src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017401 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017402 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017403 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017404 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017405
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017406src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17407 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17408 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17409 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17410 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
17411
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017412src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17413 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17414 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17415 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17416 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
17417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017418src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017419 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017420 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017421 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17422 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017423 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17424 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17425 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017426
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017427src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17428 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17429 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17430 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17431 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17432 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17433 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17434 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017436src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017437 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017438 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017439 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017440 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017441 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017443src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17444 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
17445 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17446 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17447 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017448 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017449
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017450src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17451 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
17452 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17453 the designated stick-table. This includes the both repsonse errors and 5xx
17454 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
17455 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17456
17457src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17458 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
17459 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17460 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
17461 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
17462 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
17463 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
17464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017465src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017466 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017467 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17468 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017469 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017471src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17472 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
17473 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17474 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017475 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017476 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017478src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17479 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17480 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17481 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017482 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017483 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17484 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017485
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017486 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017487 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017488 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017489 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017490
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017491src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17492 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17493 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17494 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
17495 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17496 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17497 connection when a first ACL was verified.
17498
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017499src_is_local : boolean
17500 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
17501 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
17502 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
17503 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017504 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017505 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
17506 once per connection.
17507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017508src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017509 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
17510 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
17511 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
17512 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
17513 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017515src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017516 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
17517 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17518 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
17519 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
17520 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017522src_port : integer
17523 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17524 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
17525 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
17526 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017528src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017529 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017530 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17531 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
17532 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017533 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017535src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17536 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
17537 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17538 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17539 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017540 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017542src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17543 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
17544 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
17545 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
17546 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
17547 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
17548 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
17549 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
17550 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017551
17552 Example :
17553 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
17554 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
17555 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
17556 listen ssh
17557 bind :22
17558 mode tcp
17559 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017560 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017561 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017562 server local 127.0.0.1:22
17563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017564srv_id : integer
17565 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
17566 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017567 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020017568
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017569srv_name : string
17570 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
17571 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017572 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017573
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200175747.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017575----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020017576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017577The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
17578closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
17579when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
17580usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017581future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017582
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001758351d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
17584 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
17585 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
17586 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
17587 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
17588 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17589
17590 Example :
17591 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
17592 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
17593 # the request.
17594 frontend http-in
17595 bind *:8081
17596 default_backend servers
17597 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17598 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17599
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017600ssl_bc : boolean
17601 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17602 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017603 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17604 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017605
17606ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
17607 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017608 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17609 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017610
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017611ssl_bc_alpn : string
17612 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
17613 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017614 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017615 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17616 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17617 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
17618 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
17619 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017620 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
17621 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017622
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017623ssl_bc_cipher : string
17624 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017625 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17626 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017627
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017628ssl_bc_client_random : binary
17629 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17630 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17631 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017632 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017633
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017634ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
17635 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17636 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017637 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17638 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017639
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017640ssl_bc_npn : string
17641 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
17642 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017643 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017644 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
17645 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
17646 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
17647 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017648 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
17649 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017650
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017651ssl_bc_protocol : string
17652 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017653 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17654 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017655
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017656ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017657 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017658 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017659 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
17660 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017661
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017662ssl_bc_server_random : binary
17663 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17664 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17665 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017666 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017667
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017668ssl_bc_session_id : binary
17669 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
17670 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017671 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17672 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017673
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017674ssl_bc_session_key : binary
17675 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
17676 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17677 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017678 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017679
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017680ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
17681 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017682 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17683 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017685ssl_c_ca_err : integer
17686 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17687 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
17688 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
17689 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
17690 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017692ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
17693 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17694 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
17695 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
17696 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017697
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017698ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017699 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
17700 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17701 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050017702 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017703 does not support resumed sessions.
17704
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017705ssl_c_der : binary
17706 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
17707 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17708 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017710ssl_c_err : integer
17711 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17712 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
17713 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
17714 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
17715 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017716
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017717ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017718 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17719 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17720 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17721 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17722 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17723 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17724 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17725 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017726 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17727 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17728 LDAP v3.
17729 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17730 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017732ssl_c_key_alg : string
17733 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17734 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17735 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017737ssl_c_notafter : string
17738 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
17739 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17740 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017742ssl_c_notbefore : string
17743 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
17744 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17745 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017746
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017747ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017748 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17749 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17750 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17751 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17752 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17753 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17754 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17755 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017756 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17757 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17758 LDAP v3.
17759 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17760 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017762ssl_c_serial : binary
17763 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
17764 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17765 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017767ssl_c_sha1 : binary
17768 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
17769 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
17770 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017771 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
17772 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
17773
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017774 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017775 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017777ssl_c_sig_alg : string
17778 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17779 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17780 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017782ssl_c_used : boolean
17783 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
17784 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017786ssl_c_verify : integer
17787 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
17788 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
17789 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
17790 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017792ssl_c_version : integer
17793 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
17794 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017795
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017796ssl_f_der : binary
17797 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
17798 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17799 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17800
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017801ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017802 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17803 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17804 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17805 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017806 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017807 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17808 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17809 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017810 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17811 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17812 LDAP v3.
17813 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17814 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017816ssl_f_key_alg : string
17817 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17818 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
17819 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017821ssl_f_notafter : string
17822 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17823 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17824 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017826ssl_f_notbefore : string
17827 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17828 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17829 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017830
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017831ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017832 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17833 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17834 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17835 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17836 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17837 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17838 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17839 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017840 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17841 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17842 LDAP v3.
17843 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17844 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017846ssl_f_serial : binary
17847 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17848 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17849 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017850
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020017851ssl_f_sha1 : binary
17852 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
17853 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17854 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017856ssl_f_sig_alg : string
17857 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17858 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17859 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017861ssl_f_version : integer
17862 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17863 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17864
17865ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017866 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17867 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
17868 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
17869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017870 Example :
17871 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
17872 listen http-https
17873 bind :80
17874 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
17875 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
17876
17877ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
17878 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
17879 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17880
17881ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017882 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017883 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
17884 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
17885 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17886 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17887 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
17888 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
17889 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
17890 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
17891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017892ssl_fc_cipher : string
17893 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
17894 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020017895
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017896ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
17897 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
17898 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017899 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017900
17901ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
17902 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
17903 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017904 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017905
17906ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
17907 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
17908 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
17909 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017910 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020017911 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017912
17913ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
17914 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
17915 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017916 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017917
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017918ssl_fc_client_random : binary
17919 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17920 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17921 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17922
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017923ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
17924 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17925 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17926 transport layer.
17927 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17928 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17929 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17930 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17931
17932ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17933 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17934 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17935 transport layer.
17936 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17937 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17938 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17939 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17940
17941ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
17942 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17943 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17944 transport layer.
17945 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17946 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17947 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17948 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17949
17950ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
17951 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17952 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17953 transport layer.
17954 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17955 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17956 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17957 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17958
17959ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
17960 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17961 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17962 transport layer.
17963 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17964 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17965 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17966 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017968ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017969 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
17970 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010017971 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
17972 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
17973 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
17974 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017975
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020017976ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
17977 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
17978 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
17979 wait until the handshake happened.
17980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017981ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
17982 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017983 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
17984 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017985 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017986 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017987
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020017988ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017989 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010017990 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
17991 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017993ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017994 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017995 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
17996 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
17997 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
17998 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
17999 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18000 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18001 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018003ssl_fc_protocol : string
18004 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18005 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018006
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018007ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018008 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018009 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
18010 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018011
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018012ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18013 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18014 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18015 transport layer.
18016 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18017 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18018 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18019 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18020
18021ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18022 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18023 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18024 transport layer.
18025 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18026 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18027 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18028 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18029
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018030ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18031 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18032 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18033 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018035ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18036 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18037 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18038 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18039 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018040
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018041ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18042 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18043 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18044 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18045 BoringSSL.
18046
18047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018048ssl_fc_sni : string
18049 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18050 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
18051 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
18052 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18053 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18054
18055 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
18056 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
18057 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018058 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018059 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018061 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018062 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18063 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018065ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18066 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18067 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018068
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018069ssl_s_der : binary
18070 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18071 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18072 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18073
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018074ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18075 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18076 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18077 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018078 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018079 does not support resumed sessions.
18080
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018081ssl_s_key_alg : string
18082 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18083 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18084 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18085
18086ssl_s_notafter : string
18087 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18088 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18089 transport layer.
18090
18091ssl_s_notbefore : string
18092 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
18093 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18094 transport layer.
18095
18096ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18097 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18098 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18099 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18100 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18101 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18102 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018103 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18104 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018105 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18106 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18107 LDAP v3.
18108 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18109 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18110
18111ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18112 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18113 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18114 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18115 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18116 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18117 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018118 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18119 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018120 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18121 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18122 LDAP v3.
18123 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18124 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18125
18126ssl_s_serial : binary
18127 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
18128 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18129 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18130
18131ssl_s_sha1 : binary
18132 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
18133 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18134 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18135
18136ssl_s_sig_alg : string
18137 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18138 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18139 layer.
18140
18141ssl_s_version : integer
18142 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
18143 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018144
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200181457.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018146------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018148Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
18149sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
18150only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
18151For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
18152be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
18153can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
18154sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
18155for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
18156content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018158payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018159 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018160 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
18161 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018163payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
18164 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018165 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018166 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018168req.len : integer
18169req_len : integer (deprecated)
18170 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18171 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18172 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18173 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18174 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18175 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18176 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18177 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018179req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18180 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018181 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18182 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18183 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
18184 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018186 ACL alternatives :
18187 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018189req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18190 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18191 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18192 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
18193 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018195 ACL alternatives :
18196 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018198 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018200req.proto_http : boolean
18201req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
18202 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
18203 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
18204 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
18205 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
18206 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
18207 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
18208 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018210 Example:
18211 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
18212 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18213 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018214 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018216req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
18217rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18218 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
18219 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
18220 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
18221 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
18222 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
18223 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
18224 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018226 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
18227 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
18228 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
18229 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
18230 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
18231 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018233 ACL derivatives :
18234 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018236 Example :
18237 listen tse-farm
18238 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
18239 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
18240 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18241 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
18242 # apply RDP cookie persistence
18243 persist rdp-cookie
18244 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
18245 # This is only useful makes sense if
18246 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
18247 stick-table type string size 204800
18248 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
18249 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
18250 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018252 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
18253 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018255req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
18256rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
18257 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
18258 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
18259 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
18260 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018262 ACL derivatives :
18263 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018264
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018265req.ssl_alpn : string
18266 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
18267 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
18268 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
18269 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
18270 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
18271 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018272 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018273
18274 Examples :
18275 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18276 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18277 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018278 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018279 default_backend bk_default
18280
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018281req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
18282 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
18283 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018284 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
18285 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
18286 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
18287 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
18288 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018290req.ssl_hello_type : integer
18291req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18292 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18293 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
18294 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18295 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18296 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
18297 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18298 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018300req.ssl_sni : string
18301req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
18302 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
18303 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
18304 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
18305 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18306 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020018307 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
18308 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
18309 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
18310 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
18311 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
18312 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
18313 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
18314 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
18315 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018317 ACL derivatives :
18318 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018320 Examples :
18321 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18322 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18323 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
18324 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
18325 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018326
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053018327req.ssl_st_ext : integer
18328 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
18329 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
18330 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
18331 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
18332 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
18333 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
18334 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
18335 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
18336 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
18337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018338req.ssl_ver : integer
18339req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
18340 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
18341 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
18342 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
18343 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
18344 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18345 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
18346 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018347 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018348 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018350 ACL derivatives :
18351 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018352
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018353res.len : integer
18354 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18355 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18356 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18357 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18358 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18359 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18360 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018361 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018363res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18364 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018365 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018366 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018367 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018368 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018370res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18371 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18372 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18373 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018374 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
18375 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018377 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018378
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020018379res.ssl_hello_type : integer
18380rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18381 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18382 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
18383 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18384 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18385 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
18386 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18387 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
18388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018389wait_end : boolean
18390 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
18391 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018392 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018393 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
18394 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018395 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018396 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
18397 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018399 Examples :
18400 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
18401 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
18402 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018404 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
18405 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18406 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
18407 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
18408 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
18409 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
18410 tcp-request content reject
18411
18412
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200184137.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018414--------------------------------------
18415
18416It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
18417This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
18418data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
18419its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
18420HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
18421content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
18422to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
18423more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
18424response are indexed.
18425
18426base : string
18427 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18428 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
18429 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
18430 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
18431 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
18432 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
18433 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
18434 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
18435
18436 ACL derivatives :
18437 base : exact string match
18438 base_beg : prefix match
18439 base_dir : subdir match
18440 base_dom : domain match
18441 base_end : suffix match
18442 base_len : length match
18443 base_reg : regex match
18444 base_sub : substring match
18445
18446base32 : integer
18447 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
18448 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
18449 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018450 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
18451 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
18452 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018453
18454base32+src : binary
18455 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
18456 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
18457 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
18458 per-URL counters.
18459
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018460capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
18461 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
18462 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18463 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
18464
18465capture.req.method : string
18466 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
18467 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
18468 because it's allocated.
18469
18470capture.req.uri : string
18471 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
18472 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
18473 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
18474 allocated.
18475
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018476capture.req.ver : string
18477 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18478 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
18479 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
18480
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018481capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
18482 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
18483 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18484 The first entry is an index of 0.
18485 See also: "capture response header"
18486
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018487capture.res.ver : string
18488 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18489 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
18490 persistent flag.
18491
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018492req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018493 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
18494 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
18495 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018496
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020018497req.body_param([<name>) : string
18498 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
18499 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
18500 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
18501 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
18502 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
18503 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
18504 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
18505 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
18506 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
18507 given.
18508
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018509req.body_len : integer
18510 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
18511 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018512 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
18513 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018514
18515req.body_size : integer
18516 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018517 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18518 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018520req.cook([<name>]) : string
18521cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18522 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18523 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
18524 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
18525 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
18526 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
18527 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
18528 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
18529 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
18530
18531 ACL derivatives :
18532 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
18533 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
18534 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
18535 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
18536 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
18537 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
18538 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
18539 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018541req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18542cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18543 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18544 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018546req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18547cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18548 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18549 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
18550 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
18551 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018553cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18554 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18555 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
18556 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
18557 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018558 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018559 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
18560 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
18561 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
18562 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018564hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18565 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
18566 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
18567 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
18568 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018569 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018571req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018572 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
18573 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
18574 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
18575 with headers such as User-Agent.
18576
18577 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
18578 found.
18579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018580 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18581 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18582 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018583 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018585req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18586 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18587 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018588 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
18589 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018591req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018592 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
18593 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
18594 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
18595 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
18596 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
18597 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
18598 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
18599
18600 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
18601 found.
18602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018603 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18604 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18605 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018606 with -1 being the last one.
18607
18608 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
18609 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018611 ACL derivatives :
18612 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18613 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18614 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18615 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18616 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18617 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18618 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18619 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18620
18621req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18622hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
18623 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18624 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018625 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
18626 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
18627 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
18628
18629 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
18630 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
18631 which contain more than one of certain headers.
18632
18633 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018634
18635req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18636hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18637 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
18638 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
18639 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018640 of every header is checked.
18641
18642 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
18643
18644 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018645
18646req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18647hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18648 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
18649 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
18650 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018651
18652 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
18653
18654 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018655
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010018656req.hdrs : string
18657 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
18658 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18659 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18660 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
18661
18662req.hdrs_bin : binary
18663 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18664 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
18665 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
18666 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
18667 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
18668 names and values (length of 0 for both).
18669
18670 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018671
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010018672 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18673 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018675http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
18676 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
18677 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
18678 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18679 basic auth is supported.
18680
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018681http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
18682 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
18683 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
18684 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
18685 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018686 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18687 basic auth is supported.
18688
18689 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018690 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
18691 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
18692 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
18693 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018694
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018695http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018696 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
18697 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18698 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018699
18700http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018701 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
18702 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18703 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018704
18705http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018706 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
18707 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
18708 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018710http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018711 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
18712 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018713 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
18714 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018716method : integer + string
18717 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
18718 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
18719 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
18720 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
18721 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
18722 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
18723 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018725 ACL derivatives :
18726 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018728 Example :
18729 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
18730 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
18731 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018733path : string
18734 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
18735 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
18736 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
18737 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
18738 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018739 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018740 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018742 ACL derivatives :
18743 path : exact string match
18744 path_beg : prefix match
18745 path_dir : subdir match
18746 path_dom : domain match
18747 path_end : suffix match
18748 path_len : length match
18749 path_reg : regex match
18750 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018751
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020018752pathq : string
18753 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
18754 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
18755 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
18756 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
18757 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
18758 result in both cases.
18759
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018760query : string
18761 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
18762 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
18763 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
18764 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018765 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018766 which stops before the question mark.
18767
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018768req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18769 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18770 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18771 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
18772 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
18773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018774req.ver : string
18775req_ver : string (deprecated)
18776 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
18777 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
18778 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018780 ACL derivatives :
18781 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018782
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018783res.body : binary
18784 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
18785 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018786 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
18787
18788 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018789
18790res.body_len : integer
18791 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
18792 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018793 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
18794
18795 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018796
18797res.body_size : integer
18798 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
18799 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18800 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
18801 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018802 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
18803
18804 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018805
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010018806res.cache_hit : boolean
18807 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
18808 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
18809
18810res.cache_name : string
18811 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
18812 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
18813 empty string.
18814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018815res.comp : boolean
18816 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
18817 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
18818 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018820res.comp_algo : string
18821 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
18822 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
18823 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018825res.cook([<name>]) : string
18826scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18827 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18828 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018829 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
18830
18831 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018833 ACL derivatives :
18834 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018836res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18837scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18838 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18839 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018840 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
18841
18842 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018844res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18845scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18846 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18847 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018848 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
18849
18850 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018852res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018853 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
18854 on the headers within an HTTP response.
18855
18856 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
18857 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
18858
18859 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
18860
18861 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018863res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018864 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
18865 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
18866
18867 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
18868 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
18869
18870 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018872res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18873shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018874 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
18875 on the headers within an HTTP response.
18876
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050018877 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018878 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
18879
18880 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018882 ACL derivatives :
18883 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18884 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18885 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18886 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18887 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18888 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18889 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18890 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18891
18892res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18893shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018894 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
18895 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
18896
18897 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050018898 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018899
18900 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018902res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18903shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018904 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
18905 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
18906
18907 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
18908
18909 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018910
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018911res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18912 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18913 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18914 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018915 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
18916
18917 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018919res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18920shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018921 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
18922 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
18923
18924 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
18925
18926 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018927
18928res.hdrs : string
18929 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
18930 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18931 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018932 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
18933
18934 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018935
18936res.hdrs_bin : binary
18937 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18938 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
18939 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
18940 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
18941 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
18942 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
18943 (length of 0 for both).
18944
18945 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
18946
18947 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18948 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018950res.ver : string
18951resp_ver : string (deprecated)
18952 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018953 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
18954
18955 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018957 ACL derivatives :
18958 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018960set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18961 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18962 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018963 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018964 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018966 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
18967 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018969status : integer
18970 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
18971 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018972 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
18973
18974 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018975
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020018976unique-id : string
18977 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
18978 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
18979 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
18980 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
18981 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
18982 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
18983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018984url : string
18985 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
18986 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
18987 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
18988 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
18989 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
18990 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
18991 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018993 ACL derivatives :
18994 url : exact string match
18995 url_beg : prefix match
18996 url_dir : subdir match
18997 url_dom : domain match
18998 url_end : suffix match
18999 url_len : length match
19000 url_reg : regex match
19001 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019003url_ip : ip
19004 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19005 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19006 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19007 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19008 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19009 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19010 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019012url_port : integer
19013 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19014 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19015 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19016 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019017
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019018urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19019url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019020 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19021 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019022 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19023 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19024 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19025 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019026 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19027 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019028 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19029 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019031 ACL derivatives :
19032 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19033 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19034 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19035 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19036 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19037 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19038 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19039 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019040
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019042 Example :
19043 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19044 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19045 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19046 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019047
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019048urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019049 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19050 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19051 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019052
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019053url32 : integer
19054 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19055 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19056 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19057 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19058 is an unsigned integer.
19059
19060url32+src : binary
19061 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19062 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19063 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
19064
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020019065
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200190667.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019067---------------------------------------
19068
19069This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
19070used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
19071purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
19072There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
19073or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
19074any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
19075for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
19076
19077internal.htx.data : integer
19078 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
19079 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19080
19081internal.htx.free : integer
19082 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
19083 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19084
19085internal.htx.free_data : integer
19086 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
19087 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19088
19089internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010019090 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
19091 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
19092 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019093
19094internal.htx.nbblks : integer
19095 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
19096 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19097
19098internal.htx.size : integer
19099 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
19100 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19101
19102internal.htx.used : integer
19103 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
19104 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19105 direction.
19106
19107internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
19108 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19109 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
19110 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
19111 of the special value :
19112 * head : The oldest inserted block
19113 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019114 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019115
19116internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
19117 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19118 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
19119 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
19120 integer or one of the special value :
19121 * head : The oldest inserted block
19122 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019123 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019124
19125internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
19126 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19127 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
19128 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19129 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19130
19131 * head : The oldest inserted block
19132 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019133 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019134
19135internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
19136 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19137 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19138 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19139 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19140
19141 * head : The oldest inserted block
19142 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019143 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019144
19145internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
19146 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19147 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19148 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19149 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19150
19151 * head : The oldest inserted block
19152 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019153 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019154
19155internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
19156 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
19157 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
19158 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19159 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19160
19161 * head : The oldest inserted block
19162 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019163 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019164
19165internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
19166 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
19167 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
19168 it returns false.
19169
19170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200191717.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019172---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019173
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019174Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
19175every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020019176order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019178ACL name Equivalent to Usage
19179---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019180FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020019181HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019182HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
19183HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019184HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
19185HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
19186HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
19187HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
19188LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019189METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020019190METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019191METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
19192METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
19193METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
19194METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020019195METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019196METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020019197RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019198REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019199TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019200WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
19201---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019202
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010019203
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192048. Logging
19205----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019206
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019207One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
19208provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
19209very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
19210provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
19211state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019212to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019213headers.
19214
19215In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
19216about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
19217send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
19218
19219 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
19220 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
19221 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
19222 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
19223 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019224 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060019225 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019226
19227The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
19228allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
19229as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
19230while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
19231real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
19232delay.
19233
19234
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192358.1. Log levels
19236---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019237
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019238TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019239source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019240HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
19241in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
19242track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
19243syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
19244about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019245
19246
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192478.2. Log formats
19248----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019249
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019250HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019251and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
19252slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
19253options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019254
19255 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
19256 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
19257 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
19258 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
19259 extents.
19260
19261 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
19262 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
19263 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
19264 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
19265 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
19266
19267 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
19268 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
19269 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
19270 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
19271 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
19272
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020019273 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
19274 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
19275 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
19276 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
19277
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019278 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
19279
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019280Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
19281specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
19282field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
19283servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
19284always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
19285identifier.
19286
19287Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
19288 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
19289 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
19290 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
19291 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
19292
19293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192948.2.1. Default log format
19295-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019296
19297This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
19298as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
19299format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
19300
19301 Example :
19302 listen www
19303 mode http
19304 log global
19305 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19306
19307 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
19308 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
19309 (www/HTTP)
19310
19311 Field Format Extract from the example above
19312 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
19313 2 'Connect from' Connect from
19314 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
19315 4 'to' to
19316 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
19317 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
19318
19319Detailed fields description :
19320 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
19321 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
19322 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
19323 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
19324 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19325 and processed the connection.
19326 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
19327
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019328In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
19329"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
19330connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
19331
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019332It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
19333will eventually disappear.
19334
19335
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193368.2.2. TCP log format
19337---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019338
19339The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
19340is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
19341information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
19342counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
19343emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
19344environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
19345the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
19346sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019347specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
19348not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
19349fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
19350marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019351
19352 Example :
19353 frontend fnt
19354 mode tcp
19355 option tcplog
19356 log global
19357 default_backend bck
19358
19359 backend bck
19360 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19361
19362 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
19363 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
19364 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
19365
19366 Field Format Extract from the example above
19367 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
19368 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
19369 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
19370 4 frontend_name fnt
19371 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
19372 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
19373 7 bytes_read* 212
19374 8 termination_state --
19375 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
19376 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19377
19378Detailed fields description :
19379 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019380 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19381 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19382 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019383 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019384 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019385 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019386
19387 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019388 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19389 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19390 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019391
19392 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
19393 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
19394 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019395 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
19396 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
19397 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
19398 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019399
19400 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19401 and processed the connection.
19402
19403 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19404 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19405 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
19406 applications.
19407
19408 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19409 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19410 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19411 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
19412 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
19413
19414 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19415 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
19416 See "Timers" below for more details.
19417
19418 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19419 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
19420 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
19421 "Timers" below for more details.
19422
19423 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019424 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019425 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
19426 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
19427 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
19428 details.
19429
19430 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
19431 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
19432 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
19433 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
19434 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
19435
19436 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19437 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19438 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
19439 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
19440 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
19441 for more details.
19442
19443 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019444 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019445 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
19446 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
19447 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019448 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019449
19450 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19451 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19452 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19453 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19454 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19455 caused by a denial of service attack.
19456
19457 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19458 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19459 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19460 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19461 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19462 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19463 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19464 denial of service attack.
19465
19466 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19467 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19468 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19469 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19470 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19471 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19472 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19473 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
19474 be processed than on other servers.
19475
19476 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19477 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19478 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19479 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19480 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19481 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19482 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19483 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19484 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19485 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19486 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19487 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19488 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19489
19490 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19491 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19492 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19493 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19494 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19495 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019496 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019497 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19498
19499 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19500 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19501 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19502 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19503 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19504 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019505 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019506 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19507 occurs.
19508
19509
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200195108.2.3. HTTP log format
19511----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019512
19513The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
19514is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
19515the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
19516are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
19517emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
19518generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
19519"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
19520which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019521frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
19522is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019523
19524Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
19525slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
19526with a star ('*') after the field name below.
19527
19528 Example :
19529 frontend http-in
19530 mode http
19531 option httplog
19532 log global
19533 default_backend bck
19534
19535 backend static
19536 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19537
19538 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
19539 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
19540 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019541 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019542
19543 Field Format Extract from the example above
19544 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
19545 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019546 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019547 4 frontend_name http-in
19548 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019549 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019550 7 status_code 200
19551 8 bytes_read* 2750
19552 9 captured_request_cookie -
19553 10 captured_response_cookie -
19554 11 termination_state ----
19555 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
19556 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19557 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
19558 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
19559 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019560
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019561Detailed fields description :
19562 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019563 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19564 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19565 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019566 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019567 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019568 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019569
19570 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019571 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19572 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19573 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019574
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019575 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
19576 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019577
19578 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19579 and processed the connection.
19580
19581 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19582 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19583 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
19584
19585 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19586 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19587 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19588 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
19589 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
19590 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
19591
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019592 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
19593 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
19594 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019595 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019596 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
19597 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019598 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
19599 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019600
19601 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19602 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019603 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019604
19605 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19606 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019607 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
19608 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019609
19610 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
19611 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
19612 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
19613 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
19614 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019615 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
19616 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019617
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019618 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
19619 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
19620 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
19621 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
19622 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
19623 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
19624 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019625 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019626
19627 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
19628 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
19629 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
19630
19631 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
19632 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019633 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019634 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
19635 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
19636 overflowing.
19637
19638 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
19639 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
19640 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
19641 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
19642 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
19643 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
19644 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
19645 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19646
19647 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
19648 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
19649 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
19650 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
19651 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
19652 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
19653 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
19654 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19655
19656 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19657 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19658 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
19659 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
19660 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
19661 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
19662 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
19663
19664 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019665 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019666 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
19667 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
19668 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019669 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019670 system.
19671
19672 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19673 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19674 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19675 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19676 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19677 caused by a denial of service attack.
19678
19679 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19680 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19681 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19682 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19683 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19684 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19685 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19686 denial of service attack.
19687
19688 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19689 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19690 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19691 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19692 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19693 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19694 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19695 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
19696 processed than on other servers.
19697
19698 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19699 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19700 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19701 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19702 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19703 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19704 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19705 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19706 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19707 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19708 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19709 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19710 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19711
19712 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19713 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19714 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19715 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19716 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19717 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019718 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019719 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19720
19721 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19722 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19723 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19724 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19725 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19726 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019727 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019728 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19729 occurs.
19730
19731 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
19732 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
19733 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
19734 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
19735 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
19736 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
19737 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
19738 cookies" below for more details.
19739
19740 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
19741 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
19742 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
19743 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
19744 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
19745 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
19746 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
19747 and cookies" below for more details.
19748
19749 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
19750 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
19751 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
19752 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
19753 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
19754 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
19755 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
19756 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
19757
19758
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200197598.2.4. Custom log format
19760------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019761
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019762The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019763mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019764
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019765HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019766Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
19767separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
19768prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
19769
19770Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
19771variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019772("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019773
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019774If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020019775as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019776less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
19777the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
19778
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020019779Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
19780"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
19781delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
19782preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019783
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019784Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
19785'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
19786https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
19787such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
19788
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019789Flags are :
19790 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019791 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019792 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
19793 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019794
19795 Example:
19796
19797 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
19798 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
19799
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019800 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
19801
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019802At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
19803
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019804 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
19805 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019806
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019807the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019808
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019809 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
19810 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
19811 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019812
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019813and the default TCP format is defined this way :
19814
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019815 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
19816 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019817
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019818Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
19819
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019820 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019821 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019822 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
19823 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
19824 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019825 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
19826 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
19827 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019828 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019829 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000019830 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000019831 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000019832 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019833 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
19834 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010019835 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020019836 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019837 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019838 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019839 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020019840 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080019841 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019842 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
19843 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
19844 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
19845 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
19846 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019847 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019848 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019849 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019850 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019851 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019852 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
19853 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019854 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19855 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
19856 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019857 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019858 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
19859 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019860 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019861 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19862 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
19863 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020019864 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020019865 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019866 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
19867 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
19868 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
19869 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020019870 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019871 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019872 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019873 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010019874 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019875 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019876 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
19877 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
19878 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019879 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019880 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
19881 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019882 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019883 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
19884 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020019885 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019886 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019887 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019888 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019889
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019890 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019891
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019892
198938.2.5. Error log format
19894-----------------------
19895
19896When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
19897protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
19898By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
19899"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019900will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019901logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
19902
19903The format looks like this :
19904
19905 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
19906 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
19907 Connection error during SSL handshake
19908
19909 Field Format Extract from the example above
19910 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
19911 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
19912 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
19913 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
19914 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
19915
19916These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
19917failures.
19918
19919
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199208.3. Advanced logging options
19921-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019922
19923Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
19924just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
19925options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
19926for more information about their usage.
19927
19928
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199298.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
19930------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019931
19932It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
19933haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
19934commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
19935monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
19936ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
19937
19938 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
19939 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
19940 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
19941 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
19942
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020019943 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
19944 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019945
19946 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
19947 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
19948 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
19949
19950
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199518.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
19952----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019953
19954The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
19955what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
19956or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019957"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019958just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
19959log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
19960after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
19961is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
19962with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
19963with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
19964
19965
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199668.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
19967------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019968
19969Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
19970for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
19971"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
19972retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
19973raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
19974a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
19975file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
19976you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
19977"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
19978
19979
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199808.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
19981--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019982
19983Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
19984multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
19985them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
19986"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
19987logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
19988error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
19989and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
19990too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
19991useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
19992alternative.
19993
19994
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199958.4. Timing events
19996------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019997
19998Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
19999reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20000the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20001frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020002mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20003addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20004
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020005Timings events in HTTP mode:
20006
20007 first request 2nd request
20008 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20009 t tr t tr ...
20010 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20011 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20012 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20013 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020014 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020015 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20016
20017Timings events in TCP mode:
20018
20019 TCP session
20020 |<----------------->|
20021 t t
20022 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20023 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20024 |<------ Tt ------->|
20025
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020026 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020027 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020028 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20029 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20030 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020031 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020032 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20033 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20034 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20035 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020036
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020037 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20038 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20039 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020040 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20041 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20042 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20043 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20044 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20045 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020046
20047 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20048 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20049 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20050 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20051 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20052 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20053 request typed by hand during a test.
20054
20055 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20056 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020057 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020058 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20059 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20060 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20061 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020062
20063 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
20064 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
20065 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
20066 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
20067 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
20068
20069 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
20070 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
20071 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
20072 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
20073 connection never established.
20074
20075 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
20076 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
20077 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
20078 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
20079 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
20080 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
20081 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
20082 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
20083 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
20084 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
20085 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
20086
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020087 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
20088 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
20089 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
20090 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
20091 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
20092 by subtracting other timers when valid :
20093
20094 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
20095
20096 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
20097 "Ta" can never be negative.
20098
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020099 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
20100 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020101 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
20102 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020103 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020104
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020105 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020106
20107 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020108 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
20109 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020110
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020111 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
20112 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
20113 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
20114 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
20115 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
20116 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
20117 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
20118 prefixed with a '+' sign.
20119
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020120These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
20121protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
20122that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020123due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
20124"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
20125that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020126
20127Most common cases :
20128
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020129 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
20130 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
20131 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
20132 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
20133 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
20134 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
20135 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
20136 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
20137 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
20138 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
20139 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020020140 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020141
20142 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
20143 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
20144 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
20145 of ms on remote networks.
20146
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020147 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
20148 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
20149 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020150
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020151 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
20152 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
20153 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
20154 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
20155 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
20156 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
20157 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
20158 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
20159 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020160
20161Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
20162
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020163 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020164 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020165 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020166
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020167 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020168 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
20169 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
20170
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020171 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020172 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
20173 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
20174 flags.
20175
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020176 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
20177 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020178 Check the session termination flags, then check the
20179 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
20180 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
20181 the client connection was maintained open.
20182
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020183 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020184 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020185 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020186 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
20187
20188
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201898.5. Session state at disconnection
20190-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020191
20192TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
20193"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
201942-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
20195each of which has a special meaning :
20196
20197 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
20198 session to terminate :
20199
20200 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
20201
20202 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
20203 server explicitly refused it.
20204
20205 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
20206 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
20207 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
20208 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020209 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020210
20211 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
20212 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020213
20214 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
20215 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
20216 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
20217 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
20218 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
20219
20220 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
20221 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
20222 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
20223 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
20224 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
20225
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090020226 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
20227 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
20228
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070020229 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
20230 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
20231 backup connections when going up.
20232
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020020233 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
20234
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020235 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
20236 send or receive data.
20237
20238 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
20239 send or receive data.
20240
20241 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
20242 with nothing left in the buffers.
20243
20244 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
20245
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010020246 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020247 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
20248
20249 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
20250 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
20251 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
20252 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
20253 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
20254
20255 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
20256 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
20257
20258 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
20259 server (HTTP only).
20260
20261 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
20262
20263 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
20264 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
20265 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
20266
20267 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
20268 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
20269 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
20270
20271 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
20272
20273 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
20274 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
20275
20276 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
20277 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
20278 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
20279
20280 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
20281 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020020282 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
20283 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020284
20285 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
20286 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
20287 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
20288 another server.
20289
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020290 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020291 server.
20292
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020293 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
20294 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
20295 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
20296 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20297
20298 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
20299 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
20300 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
20301 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20302
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020020303 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
20304 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
20305 "use-server" rule).
20306
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020307 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20308
20309 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
20310 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
20311
20312 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
20313
20314 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
20315 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
20316 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
20317
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020318 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
20319 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020320 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020321 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
20322 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
20323
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020324 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
20325
20326 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
20327 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
20328
20329 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
20330
20331 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20332
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020333The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
20334was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020335helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
20336starvation, attacks, etc...
20337
20338The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
20339alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
20340easier finding and understanding.
20341
20342 Flags Reason
20343
20344 -- Normal termination.
20345
20346 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
20347 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
20348 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
20349 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
20350
20351 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
20352 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
20353 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
20354 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
20355 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
20356 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020357
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020358 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20359 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020360 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020361
20362 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
20363 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
20364 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
20365
20366 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
20367 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
20368 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
20369 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
20370 the server takes too long to respond.
20371
20372 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
20373 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
20374 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
20375 long a time to respond.
20376
20377 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
20378 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
20379 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
20380 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020381 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
20382 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020383
20384 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
20385 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
20386 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
20387 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
20388 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020020389 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020390 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
20391 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
20392 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
20393 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
20394 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
20395 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
20396 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
20397 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020398 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020399 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
20400 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
20401 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020402
20403 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
20404 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020405 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
20406 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
20407 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
20408 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020409
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020410 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
20411 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
20412
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020413 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020414 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
20415 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020416 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020417 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
20418 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
20419
20420 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
20421 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
20422 503 or 504 here.
20423
20424 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
20425 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
20426 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
20427 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
20428 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
20429
20430 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20431 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020432 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020433 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
20434 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
20435
20436 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
20437 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
20438 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
20439 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
20440 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
20441 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
20442 between haproxy and the server.
20443
20444 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
20445 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
20446 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
20447 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
20448 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
20449 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
20450 solution is to fix the application.
20451
20452 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
20453 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
20454 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
20455 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
20456 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
20457 external attacks.
20458
20459 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070020460 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020461 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020462 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
20463 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
20464
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020465 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
20466 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
20467 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020468 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020020469 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020470
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020471 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
20472 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
20473 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
20474 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020475 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
20476 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
20477 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
20478 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
20479 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020480
20481 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
20482 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
20483 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
20484 returned an HTTP 403 error.
20485
20486 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
20487 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
20488 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
20489 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
20490
20491 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
20492 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
20493 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
20494 only be solved by proper system tuning.
20495
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020496The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
20497persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
20498important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
20499re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
20500
20501 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
20502
20503 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20504 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
20505 set on a GET request.
20506
20507 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
20508 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020509 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020510 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
20511
20512 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
20513 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
20514 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
20515
20516 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20517 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
20518 already got a cookie.
20519
20520 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20521 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
20522 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
20523 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
20524 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
20525
20526 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20527 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20528 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20529
20530 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
20531 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20532 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20533
20534 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
20535 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
20536
20537 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
20538 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
20539 then advertised in the response.
20540
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020541
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205428.6. Non-printable characters
20543-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020544
20545In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
20546consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
20547converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
20548prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
20549being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
20550escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
20551is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
20552'}' when logging headers.
20553
20554Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
20555issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
20556containing spaces is "User-Agent".
20557
20558Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
20559the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
20560performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
20561
20562
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205638.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
20564---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020565
20566Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
20567achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020568section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020569cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
20570the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
20571the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020572locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020573not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
20574user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
20575a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
20576wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
20577
20578 Examples :
20579 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
20580 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
20581
20582 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
20583 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
20584
20585
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205868.8. Capturing HTTP headers
20587---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020588
20589Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
20590proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
20591the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
20592server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
20593
20594Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
20595response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020596section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020597
20598It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020599time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
20600appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020601are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
20602and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
20603follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
20604request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
20605in the logs.
20606
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020607As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
20608frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
20609an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
20610
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020611 Example :
20612 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
20613 listen proxy-out
20614 mode http
20615 option httplog
20616 option logasap
20617 log global
20618 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
20619
20620 # log the name of the virtual server
20621 capture request header Host len 20
20622
20623 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
20624 capture request header Content-Length len 10
20625
20626 # log the beginning of the referrer
20627 capture request header Referer len 20
20628
20629 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
20630 capture response header Server len 20
20631
20632 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
20633 capture response header Content-Length len 10
20634
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020635 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020636 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
20637
20638 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
20639 capture response header Via len 20
20640
20641 # log the URL location during a redirection
20642 capture response header Location len 20
20643
20644 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
20645 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
20646 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20647 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
20648 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
20649
20650 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20651 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20652 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20653 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020654 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020655
20656 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20657 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20658 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20659 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
20660 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020661 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020662
20663
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206648.9. Examples of logs
20665---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020666
20667These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
20668them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
20669reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
20670
20671 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
20672 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20673 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20674
20675 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
20676 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
20677
20678 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
20679 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
20680 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20681
20682 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
20683 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
20684
20685 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
20686 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20687 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
20688
20689 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020690 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020691 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
20692 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
20693
20694 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
20695 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
20696 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
20697
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020020698 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
20699 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
20700 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
20701 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
20702 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
20703 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020704
20705 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020706 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020707
20708 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
20709 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
20710 Nothing was sent to any server.
20711
20712 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
20713 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
20714
20715 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
20716 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020717 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020718 send a 408 return code to the client.
20719
20720 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
20721 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
20722
20723 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
20724 5 seconds ("c----").
20725
20726 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
20727 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020728 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020729
20730 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020731 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020732 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
20733 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
20734 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
20735 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
20736 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020737
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020020738
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200207399. Supported filters
20740--------------------
20741
20742Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
20743accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
20744unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
20745
20746See also : "filter"
20747
207489.1. Trace
20749----------
20750
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010020751filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020752
20753 Arguments:
20754 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
20755 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
20756
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010020757 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020758
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020759 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020760 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
20761 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
20762 amount of the parsed data.
20763
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020764 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020765
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020766This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
20767callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
20768information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
20769filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
20770
20771Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
20772tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
20773a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
20774
20775
207769.2. HTTP compression
20777---------------------
20778
20779filter compression
20780
20781The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
20782keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020783when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
20784fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
20785done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
20786explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
20787filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
20788listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20789order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020790
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020791See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
20792 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020793
20794
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200207959.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
20796--------------------------------------------
20797
20798filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
20799
20800 Arguments :
20801
20802 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
20803 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
20804 parsed.
20805
20806 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
20807 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
20808 part must be placed in its own scope.
20809
20810The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
20811external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020812streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020813exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
20814also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
20815
20816SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
20817the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
20818
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020819For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020820"doc/SPOE.txt".
20821
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100208229.4. Cache
20823----------
20824
20825filter cache <name>
20826
20827 Arguments :
20828
20829 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
20830
20831The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
20832"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020833cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020834other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
20835case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
20836is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
20837filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010020838listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20839order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010020840
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020841See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
20842 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
20843
20844
208459.5. Fcgi-app
20846-------------
20847
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020848filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020849
20850 Arguments :
20851
20852 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
20853
20854The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
20855request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
20856reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
20857used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
20858implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
20859used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
20860fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
20861used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20862order.
20863
20864See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
20865 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
20866
20867
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100208689.6. OpenTracing
20869----------------
20870
20871The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
20872HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
20873of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
20874Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
20875
20876This feature is only enabled when haproxy was built with USE_OT=1.
20877
20878The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
20879HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
20880participates in the work of HAProxy.
20881
20882filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
20883
20884 Arguments :
20885
20886 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
20887 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
20888 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
20889 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
20890 OpenTracing filters.
20891
20892 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
20893 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
20894 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
20895 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
20896 filter must have its own scope defined.
20897
20898More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
20899of the filter can be found in the contrib/opentracing directory.
20900
20901
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002090210. FastCGI applications
20903-------------------------
20904
20905HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
20906feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
20907the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
20908FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
20909servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
20910FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
20911backend.
20912
20913HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
20914application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
20915connection.
20916
2091710.1. Setup
20918-----------
20919
2092010.1.1. Fcgi-app section
20921--------------------------
20922
20923fcgi-app <name>
20924 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
20925 document root must be defined.
20926
20927acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
20928 Declare or complete an access list.
20929
20930 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
20931 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
20932 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
20933 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
20934 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
20935
20936docroot <path>
20937 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
20938 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
20939 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
20940
20941index <script-name>
20942 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
20943 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
20944 is an optional setting.
20945
20946 Example :
20947 index index.php
20948
20949log-stderr global
20950log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010020951 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020952 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
20953
20954 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
20955 default STDERR messages are ignored.
20956
20957pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20958 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
20959 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
20960 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20961
20962 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
20963 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
20964 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
20965 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
20966
20967 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
20968 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
20969
20970path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020971 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020972 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
20973 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
20974 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
20975 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
20976 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
20977 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
20978 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020979
20980 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020981 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020982 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
20983 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
20984 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
20985 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020986
20987 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020988 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
20989 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020990
20991option get-values
20992no option get-values
20993 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
20994
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020995 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020996 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
20997
20998 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
20999 application will accept.
21000
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021001 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21002 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021003
21004 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021005 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021006 option is disabled.
21007
21008 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21009 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21010 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21011 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21012 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21013 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21014
21015option keep-conn
21016no option keep-conn
21017 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21018 sending a response.
21019
21020 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21021 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21022
21023option max-reqs <reqs>
21024 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21025 accept.
21026
21027 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21028 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21029 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21030 to 1.
21031
21032option mpxs-conns
21033no option mpxs-conns
21034 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21035
21036 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21037 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21038
21039set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21040 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21041 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21042 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21043 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21044
21045 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21046 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21047 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21048
21049 Example :
21050 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21051 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21052
21053 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21054
21055
2105610.1.2. Proxy section
21057---------------------
21058
21059use-fcgi-app <name>
21060 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21061
21062 Arguments :
21063 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
21064
21065 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
21066 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
21067 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
21068 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
21069 application may be defined at a time per backend.
21070
21071 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
21072 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
21073 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
21074 application are evaluated.
21075
21076
2107710.1.3. Example
21078---------------
21079
21080 frontend front-http
21081 mode http
21082 bind *:80
21083 bind *:
21084
21085 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
21086 default_backend back-static
21087
21088 backend back-static
21089 mode http
21090 server www A.B.C.D:80
21091
21092 backend back-dynamic
21093 mode http
21094 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
21095 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
21096
21097 fcgi-app php-fpm
21098 log-stderr global
21099 option keep-conn
21100
21101 docroot /var/www/my-app
21102 index index.php
21103 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
21104
21105
2110610.2. Default parameters
21107------------------------
21108
21109A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
21110the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021111script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021112applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
21113
21114 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21115 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
21116 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
21117 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
21118 | | |
21119 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21120 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
21121 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
21122 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
21123 | | application. |
21124 | | |
21125 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21126 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
21127 | | the request. It may not be set. |
21128 | | |
21129 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21130 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
21131 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
21132 | | the application's configuration. |
21133 | | |
21134 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21135 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
21136 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
21137 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
21138 | | |
21139 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21140 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
21141 | | following the part that identifies the script |
21142 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
21143 | | be defined. |
21144 | | |
21145 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21146 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
21147 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
21148 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
21149 | | is not set too. |
21150 | | |
21151 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21152 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
21153 | | set. |
21154 | | |
21155 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21156 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
21157 | | the request. |
21158 | | |
21159 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21160 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
21161 | | client as part of user authentication. |
21162 | | |
21163 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21164 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
21165 | | script to process the request. |
21166 | | |
21167 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21168 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
21169 | | |
21170 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21171 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
21172 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
21173 | | |
21174 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21175 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
21176 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
21177 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
21178 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
21179 | | |
21180 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21181 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
21182 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
21183 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
21184 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
21185 | | side. |
21186 | | |
21187 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21188 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
21189 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
21190 | | connected to. |
21191 | | |
21192 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21193 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
21194 | | |
21195 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21196 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
21197 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
21198 | | |
21199 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21200
21201
2120210.3. Limitations
21203------------------
21204
21205The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
21206way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
21207during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
21208establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
21209application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
21210or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
21211message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
21212these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
21213and HTTP servers under the same backend.
21214
21215Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
21216request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
21217requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
21218
21219About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
21220into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
21221fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
21222"http-request" ones.
21223
21224Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
21225FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
21226processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
21227must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
21228here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010021229
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021230/*
21231 * Local variables:
21232 * fill-column: 79
21233 * End:
21234 */